Promise Technology VTrak J610S Product manual

VTRAK
E-Class
E610f, E610s, E310f, E310s
PRODUCT MANUAL
Version 2.0
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Copyright
© 2007 Promise Technology, Inc. All Rights Reserved.
Copyright by Promise Technology, Inc. (Promise Technology). No part of this
manual may be reproduced or transmitted in any form without the expressed,
written permission of Promise Technology.
Trademarks
Promise, and the Promise logo are registered in U.S. Patent and Trademark
Office. All other product names mentioned herein may be trademarks or
registered trademarks of their respective companies.
Important data protection information
You should back up all data before installing any drive controller or storage
peripheral. Promise Technology is not responsible for any loss of data resulting
from the use, disuse or misuse of this or any other Promise Technology product.
Notice
Although Promise Technology has attempted to ensure the accuracy of the
content of this manual, it is possible that this document may contain technical
inaccuracies, typographical, or other errors. Promise Technology assumes no
liability for any error in this publication, and for damages, whether direct, indirect,
incidental, consequential or otherwise, that may result from such error, including,
but not limited to loss of data or profits.
Promise Technology provides this publication “as is” without warranty of any kind,
either express or implied, including, but not limited to implied warranties of
merchantability or fitness for a particular purpose.
The published information in the manual is subject to change without notice.
Promise Technology reserves the right to make changes in the product design,
layout, and driver revisions without notification to its users.
This version of the Product Manual supersedes all previous versions.
Recommendations
In this Product Manual, the appearance of products made by other companies,
including but not limited to software, servers, and disk drives, is for the purpose of
illustration and explanation only. Promise Technology does not recommend,
endorse, prefer, or support any product made by another manufacturer.
ii
Contents
Chapter 1: Introduction to VTrak . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1
About This Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1
VTrak Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2
Architectural Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4
Features and Benefits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5
Highlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5
Subsystem and Controller Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6
Operational Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6
Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8
E610f and E610s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8
E310f and E310s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8
Warranty and Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9
FCC Statement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9
CE Statement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9
MIC Statement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9
Chapter 2: VTrak Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11
Unpacking the VTrak . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11
Mounting VTrak E610f/s in a Rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12
Mounting VTrak E310f/s in a Rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14
Installing Disk Drives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17
Drive Slot Numbering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17
AAMUX Adapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18
Installing Disk Drives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18
Making Management and Data Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Fibre Channel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Serial Attached SCSI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26
Making Serial Cable Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32
Connecting the Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Chapter 3: VTrak Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Setting up the Serial Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Choosing DHCP or a Static IP Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36
Setting up VTrak with the CLI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37
Setting up VTrak with the CLU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
Setting system date and time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
Making Management Port settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
Viewing IP address and settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
Making Controller Maintenance Mode Settings . . . . . . . . . . . .40
iii
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Chapter 3: VTrak Setup, cont.
Setting up VTrak with the CLU, cont.
Exiting the CLU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
Creating Disk Arrays with WebPAM PROe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
Logging into WebPAM PROe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
Selecting a Language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
Creating a Disk Array . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
Logging out of WebPAM PROe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
Using WebPAM PROe over the Internet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49
Obtaining a Security Certificate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .51
Logging into WebPAM PROe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52
Selecting a Language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
Perusing the Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55
Using the Header . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56
Using Tree View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .57
Using Management View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58
Viewing the Event Frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58
Logging out of WebPAM PROe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .59
Working with the Storage Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
Viewing Other Subsytems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
Updating the List of Subsystems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
Logging into a Subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
Hiding the Other Subsystems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
Working with Subsystems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .61
Viewing Subsystem Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .61
Saving Subsystem Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62
Setting an Alias for the Subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62
Setting Redundancy for the Subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62
Setting Cache Mirroring for the Subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62
Setting Subsystem Date and Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .63
Viewing the Runtime Event Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .63
Saving the Runtime Event Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .64
Clearing the Runtime Event Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .64
Viewing NVRAM Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65
Saving NVRAM Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65
Clearing NVRAM Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66
Viewing Current Background Activities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66
Making Background Activity Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66
Running Background Activities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
iv
Contents
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe, cont.
Working with Subsystems, cont.
Running Media Patrol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68
Running PDM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68
Viewing Scheduled Activities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68
Scheduling an Activity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Deleting a Scheduled Activity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
Viewing Lock Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
Setting the Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
Renewing the Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71
Releasing the Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71
Managing Users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
Viewing User Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
Making User Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
Making Your Own User Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73
Setting-up User Event Subscriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73
Changing Another User’s Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Changing Your Own Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Creating a User . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
Deleting a User . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
Viewing User Sessions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
Logging out Other Users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
Managing the Network Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77
Making Subsystem Management Port Settings . . . . . . . . . . . .77
Making Controller Management Port Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . .77
Managing Fibre Channel Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79
Viewing Fibre Channel Node Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79
Viewing Fibre Channel Port Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79
Making Fibre Channel Port Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80
Viewing Fibre Channel Port Statistics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81
Viewing SFP Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81
Viewing Fibre Channel Logged-in Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82
Viewing Fibre Channel Initiators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82
Managing SAS Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84
Viewing SAS Port Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84
Making SAS Port Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84
Viewing SAS Port Statistics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
Viewing SAS Initiators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
Managing Storage Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87
Adding an Initiator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87
Deleting an Initiator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88
v
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe, cont.
Managing Storage Services, cont.
Viewing the LUN Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88
Enabling LUN Masking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88
Adding a LUN Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88
Editing a LUN Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89
Managing Software Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90
Making Email Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90
Making SLP Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91
Making Web Server Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91
Making Telnet Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93
Making SNMP Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93
Making CIM Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .95
Making Netsend Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96
Exporting the User Database . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
Importing a User Database . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99
Updating the Firmware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100
Restoring Factory Defaults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Clearing Statistics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102
Shutting Down the Subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103
Monitoring the Shutdown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103
Restarting the Subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
Monitoring the Restart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
Managing Controllers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105
Viewing the Controllers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105
Locating a Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105
Viewing Controller Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
Viewing Controller Statistics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
Making Controller Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
Clearing an Orphan Watermark . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108
Managing Enclosures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
Viewing the Enclosures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
Locating an Enclosure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
Viewing Enclosure Topology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
Viewing Enclosure Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
Making Enclosure Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
Viewing FRU VPD Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
Checking the Batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
Reconditioning a Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114
Silencing the Buzzer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114
Making Buzzer Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .115
vi
Contents
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe, cont.
Managing Enclosures, cont.
Testing the Buzzer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .115
Managing Physical Drives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116
Viewing a List of Physical Drives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116
Identifying a Physical Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116
Making Global Physical Drive Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116
Viewing Physical Drive Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .117
Viewing Physical Drive Statistics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118
Making Physical Drive Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118
Clearing Stale and PFA Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
Forcing a Physical Drive Offline or Online . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
Managing Disk Arrays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121
Viewing Disk Arrays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121
Creating a Disk Array . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121
Creating a Disk Array – Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .122
Creating a Disk Array – Express . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .122
Creating a Disk Array – Advanced . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123
Deleting a Disk Array . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .125
Viewing Disk Array Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126
Making Disk Array Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127
Creating a Logical Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127
Deleting a Logical Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .129
Migrating a Disk Array . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .129
Rebuilding a Disk Array . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130
Running Media Patrol on a Disk Array . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .131
Running PDM on a Disk Array . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .131
Transitioning a Disk Array . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132
Preparing a Disk Array for Transport . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132
Managing Logical Drives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134
Viewing Information for All Logical Drives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134
Viewing Logical Drive Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135
Viewing Logical Drive Statistics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136
Making Logical Drive Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136
Initializing a Logical Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
Running Redundancy Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
Viewing the Logical Drive Check Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .138
Making Logical Drive LUN Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .139
Managing Spare Drives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141
Viewing a List of Spare Drives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141
Locating a Spare Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141
vii
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe, cont.
Managing Spare Drives, cont.
Creating a Spare Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142
Deleting Spare Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Making Spare Drive Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Running Spare Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .144
Working with the Logical Drive Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145
Viewing a List of All Logical Drives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145
Viewing Individual Logical Drive Information . . . . . . . . . . . . .145
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147
Logging into the CLU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148
Making a Serial Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148
Making a Telnet Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148
Accessing Online Help . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
Logging out of the CLU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
Running Quick Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151
Managing the Subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152
Setting an Alias for the Subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152
Setting Redundancy for the Subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152
Setting Cache Mirroring for the Subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152
Running Media Patrol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .153
Locking or Unlocking the Subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .153
Setting Subsystem Date and Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154
Managing the Controllers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Viewing Controller Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Clearing an Orphan Watermark . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Making Controller Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .156
Locating the Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157
Managing the Enclosure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158
Viewing Enclosure Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158
Viewing Power Supply Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158
Locating a Power Supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159
Viewing Blower Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159
Viewing Voltage Sensor Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159
Viewing Temperature Sensor Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159
Setting Temperature Thresholds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
Checking the Batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
Reconditioning a Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
Locating an Enclosure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
Viewing Enclosure Topology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
viii
Contents
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU, cont.
Managing Physical Drives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162
Making Global Physical Drive Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162
Setting an Alias . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163
Viewing Advanced Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163
Viewing Physical Drive Statistics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163
Clearing Stale and PFA Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163
Forcing a Physical Drive Offline or Online . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
Locating a Physical Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
Managing Disk Arrays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
Creating a Disk Array . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
Creating a Disk Array – Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
Creating a Disk Array – Express . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167
Creating a Disk Array – Advanced . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
Deleting a Disk Array . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .169
Viewing Disk Array Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170
Setting an Alias for a Disk Array . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170
Accepting an Incomplete Array . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .171
Enabling Media Patrol on a Disk Array . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .171
Enabling PDM on a Disk Array . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .171
Preparing the Disk Array for Transport . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .171
Rebuilding a Disk Array . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
Migrating a Disk Array . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
Running PDM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
Running Transition on a Disk Array . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
Locating a Disk Array . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174
Creating a Logical Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174
Deleting a Logical Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .175
Managing Logical Drives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .176
Viewing Logical Drive Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .176
Setting an Alias for a Logical Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .176
Setting Write Cache Policy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .176
Setting Read Cache Policy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
Setting Preferred Controller ID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
Initializing a Logical Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
Running Redundancy Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178
Locating a Logical Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178
Managing the Network Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .179
Making Subsystem Management Port Settings . . . . . . . . . . .179
Making Controller Maintenance Mode Settings . . . . . . . . . . .179
ix
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU, cont.
Managing Fibre Channel Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .181
Viewing Node Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .181
Viewing Fibre Channel Logged-in Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .181
Making Fibre Channel Port Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .181
Viewing SFP Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182
Viewing Fibre Channel Port Statistics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182
Viewing Fibre Channel Initiators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183
Adding a Fibre Channel Initiator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183
Managing SAS Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .184
Viewing SAS Port Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .184
Making SAS Port Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .184
Viewing SAS Port Statistics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .185
Viewing SAS Initiators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .185
Adding a SAS Initiator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .185
Managing Background Activity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .186
Viewing Current Background Activities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .186
Making Background Activity Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .186
Working with the Event Viewer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188
Viewing Runtime Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188
Clearing Runtime Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188
Viewing NVRAM Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188
Clearing NVRAM Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .189
Managing Spare Drives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .190
Viewing a list of Spare Drives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .190
Creating a Spare Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .190
Making Spare Drive Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .191
Running Spare Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .191
Deleting a Spare Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .192
Working with LUN Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .193
Viewing a List of Initiators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .193
Enabling LUN Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .193
Creating an Initiator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .193
Mapping a LUN to an Initiator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .194
Deleting an Initiator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .194
Managing Users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196
Viewing User Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196
Creating a User . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196
Changing a User’s Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .197
Changing a User’s Display Name and Email Address . . . . . .197
Changing a User’s Privilege and Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198
x
Contents
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU, cont.
Managing Users, cont.
Deleting a User . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198
Working with Software Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .199
Making Email Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .199
Making SLP Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .200
Making Webserver Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .200
Making Telnet Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .201
Making SNMP Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .201
Managing SNMP Trap Sinks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .202
Making CIM Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203
Making Netsend Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203
Managing Netsend Recipients . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204
Flashing through TFTP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206
Clearing Statistics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .207
Restoring Factory Defaults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .208
Shutting Down the Subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .209
Shutting down the VTrak – Telnet Connection . . . . . . . . . . . .209
Shutting down the VTrak – Serial Connection . . . . . . . . . . . .209
Restarting the Subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .211
Restarting VTrak – Telnet Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .211
Restarting VTrak – Serial Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .211
Making Buzzer Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .212
Chapter 6: Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .213
Updating the Firmware in WebPAM PROe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .213
Downloading the Firmware Image File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .213
Updating Firmware from TFTP Server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .213
Updating Firmware from your PC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
Restarting the Subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215
Updating the Firmware in the CLU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216
Downloading the Firmware Image File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216
Updating the Firmware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216
Restarting Subsystem over a Telnet Connection . . . . . . . . . .216
Restarting Subsystem over a Serial Connection . . . . . . . . . .217
Replacing a Power Supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .218
Remove the Old Power Supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .218
Install a New Power Supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .218
Replacing a Cooling Unit Fan or Blower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .219
Replacing a Cache Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
xi
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Chapter 6: Maintenance, cont.
Replacing a RAID Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228
Dual Controller Subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228
Single Controller Subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .229
Chapter 7: Technology Background . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231
Introduction to RAID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231
RAID 0 – Stripe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232
RAID 1 – Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233
RAID 1E – Enhanced Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234
RAID 5 – Block and Parity Stripe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235
RAID 6 – Block and Double Parity Stripe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .236
RAID 10 – Mirror + Stripe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .237
RAID 50 – Striping of Distributed Parity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .238
RAID 60 – Striping of Double Parity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
Choosing a RAID Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .242
RAID 0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .242
RAID 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .242
RAID 1E . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .243
RAID 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .243
RAID 6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .243
RAID 10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244
RAID 50 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244
RAID 60 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244
Choosing Stripe Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245
Choosing Sector Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245
2 TB Limitation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .246
Cache Policy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .246
Read Cache Policy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247
Write Cache Policy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247
Adaptive Writeback Cache . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247
Cache Mirroring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248
Failover and Failback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248
LUN Affinity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .249
Disk Array Creation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .249
Logical Drive Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .250
Failover and Failback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .250
Capacity Coercion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .250
Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .251
Hot Spare Drive(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .251
Partition and Format the Logical Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252
xii
Contents
Chapter 7: Technology Background, cont.
RAID Level Migration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252
Ranges of Disk Array Expansion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254
Media Patrol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255
Predictive Data Migration (PDM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .256
PDM Triggers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .256
Transition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .261
VTrak is Beeping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262
LEDs Display Amber or Red . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
Front Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
Drive Status Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .264
Back of Enclosure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .265
CLU Reports a Problem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
Viewing Runtime Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
Viewing NVRAM Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
Checking a Reported Component . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270
WebPAM PROe Reports a Problem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271
Event Notification Response . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274
Critical & Offline Disk Arrays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289
When a Physical Drive Fails . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289
With a Hot Spare Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289
Without a Hot Spare Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .290
Rebuild Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .290
Incomplete Array . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .292
Physical Drive Problems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .293
Physical Drive Offline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .293
Physical Drive Not Usable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .293
Physical Drive Failed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .293
Enclosure Problems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .295
Controller Enters Maintenance Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .298
Connection Problems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .299
Serial Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .299
Network Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .299
Fibre Channel Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .300
Browser Does Not Connect to WebPAM PROe . . . . . . . . . . . . . .301
Unsaved Data in the Controller Cache . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .302
xiii
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Chapter 9: Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .303
Frequently Asked Questions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .303
Contacting Technical Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .305
Limited Warranty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .308
Returning Product For Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .309
Appendix A: Useful Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .311
SNMP MIB Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .311
Load MIB Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .311
Adding a Second Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .311
Installing a Second Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .311
Dual Controllers and SATA Drives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .312
Installing a Second Cache Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .313
Index. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .315
xiv
Chapter 1: Introduction to VTrak
This chapter covers the following topics:
•
About This Manual (below)
•
VTrak Overview (page 2)
•
Architectural Description (page 4)
•
Specifications (page 8)
Thank you for purchasing Promise Technology’s VTrak E-Class external disk
array subsystem.
About This Manual
This Product Manual describes how to setup, use and maintain the VTrak E610f,
E610s, E310f, and E310s external disk array subsystems. It also describes how
to use the built-in command-line interface (CLI), command-line utility (CLU) and
embedded Web-based Promise Array Management—Professional (WebPAM
PROe) software.
This manual includes a full table of contents, index, chapter task lists and
numerous cross-references to help you find the specific information you are
looking for.
Also included are four levels of notices:
Note
A Note provides helpful information such as hints or alternative
ways of doing a task.
Important
An Important calls attention to an essential step or point required
to complete a task. Important items include things often missed.
Caution
A Caution informs you of possible equipment damage or loss of
data and how to avoid them.
1
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Warning
A Warning notifies you of probable equipment damage or loss of
data, or the possibility of physical injury, and how to avoid them.
VTrak Overview
VTrak provides data storage solutions for applications where high performance
and data protection are required. The failure of any single drive will not affect data
integrity or accessibility of the data in a RAID protected logical drive.
Figure 1. VTrak E610f/s front view
Drive Carrier LEDs
Drive Carriers
Power and Status LEDs
Figure 2. VTrak E310f/s front view
Drive Carrier LEDs
Drive Carriers
Power and Status LEDs
A defective drive may be replaced without interruption of data availability to the
host computer. If so configured, a hot spare drive will automatically replace a
failed drive, securing the fault-tolerant integrity of the logical drive. The selfcontained hardware-based RAID logical drive provides maximum performance in
a compact external chassis.
2
Chapter 1: Introduction to VTrak
Figure 3. VTrak E610f rear view
RAID Controller 1
RAID Controller 2
Mgmt
FC 1
4
2
FC 2
Mgmt
UPS
FC 1
4
2
1
1
Gb/s
Gb/s
4
2
115200
8N1
FC 2
UPS
4
2
1
1
Gb/s
Gb/s
115200
8N1
Power Supply 1 Cooling Unit 1 Cooling Unit 2 Power Supply 2
with Battery
with Battery
Figure 4. VTrak E610s rear view
RAID Controller 1
RAID Controller 2
Mgmt
Mgmt
UPS
115200
8N1
UPS
115200
8N1
Power Supply 1 Cooling Unit 1 Cooling Unit 2 Power Supply 2
with Battery
with Battery
3
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Figure 5. VTrak E310f rear view
Power Supply 1 Cooling Unit 1 Cooling Unit 2 Power Supply 2
with Battery
with Battery
I
I
O
O
Mgmt
FC 1
FC 2
4
Mgmt
UPS
FC 1
4
2
2
1
1
Gb/s
Gb/s
4
2
115200
8N1
FC 2
UPS
4
2
1
1
Gb/s
Gb/s
115200
8N1
RAID Controller 2
RAID Controller 1
Figure 6. VTrak E310s rear view
Power Supply 1 Cooling Unit 1 Cooling Unit 2 Power Supply 2
with Battery
with Battery
I
I
O
O
Mgmt
Mgmt
UPS
115200
8N1
UPS
115200
8N1
Controller 2
Controller 1
Architectural Description
The VTrak E610f and E310f are Fibre Channel subsystems suitable for Direct
Attached Storage (DAS), Storage Area Network (SAN), and Expanded Storage.
The VTrak E610s and E310s are Serial Attached SCSI (SAS) subsystems
suitable for Direct Attached Storage (DAS), Cascaded Storage, and Expanded
Storage.
The E-Class subsystems support:
•
1.5 Gb/s SATA disk drives
•
3.0 Gb/s SATA disk drives
•
3.0 Gb/s SAS disk drives
4
Chapter 1: Introduction to VTrak
All E-Class enclosures include a mid-plane, RAID controller, power and cooling
units, and enclosure processor all in one cable-less chassis design. Multiple fans
and power supplies provide redundancy to ensure continued usage during
component failure. The RAID controller is hardware based and controls all logical
drive functions transparently to the host system. VTrak appears to the computer’s
operating system as a standard SCSI drive or drives.
Features and Benefits
Highlights
•
Dual channel active/active, failover/failback RAID controllers
•
E610f/s: 16 hot-swappable drive bays in a robust 3U rackmount chassis with
redundant, hot-swappable power and cooling modules
•
E310f/s: 12 hot-swappable drive bays in a robust 2U rackmount chassis with
redundant, hot-swappable power and cooling modules
•
Supports for Serial Attached SCSI (SAS) and Serial ATA (SATA) 3 Gb/s
drives simultaneously in the same system—choose the drive that is best
suited to your application
•
Direct SATA LED support with AAMUX adapter
•
Dual 4 Gb/s Fibre Channel or four 3 Gb/s SAS x4 host ports provide highavailability SAN and cluster-friendly platform
•
JBOD expansion support through a 3 Gb/s SAS x4 port—up to four VTrak
JBOD systems
•
Simplified remote management with a comprehensive embedded webbased management via Ethernet—WebPAM PROe. Command Line
Interface/Utility via RJ-11 Serial Port
•
Three years complete system limited warranty includes 24 x 7 email and
phone support with highly experienced technical support technicians and an
advanced replacements program
•
Support for the latest RAID technology—RAID 6 and 60—Protection from a
catastrophic double drive failure
•
Resilient data protection features such as Predictive Data Migration™ and
PerfectRAID™ provide rock solid data protection
•
LUN Mapping and Masking bring flexibility for multiple application and OS
support on the same storage subsystem
•
Open architecture, industry’s most comprehensive support for SAS and
SATA hard drives and standards-based management interfaces including
SNMP, CIM, and WBEM
5
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
•
Support for the industry standard Disk Data Format (DDF from SNIA)
ensures interoperability and drive roaming even among different RAID
vendors
•
Compatible with leading SAS hard drives, host bus adapters and RAID
controllers
Subsystem and Controller Features
Controllers: Dual-controller configuration or single-controller configuration,
upgradeable to dual. Dual-controller subsystems feature Active/Active, Failover/
Failback.
Drive Support: Up to 16 (E610f/s) or 12 (E310f/s) 3.5" x 1" hard disk drives: SAS
3Gb/s, SATA II 3Gb/s and 1.5Gb/s. SATA drives require an AAMUX Adapter in
dual I/O module configuration (dual-controller) subsystems.
Supports any mix of SAS and SATA II 3Gb/s or 1.5Gb/s drives simultaneously in
the same system. Staggered physical drive spin-up.
External I/O Ports (per controller): Dual 4-Gb Fibre Channel host port; One
external 3 Gb/s SAS x4 ports for JBOD expansion (up to four VTrak JBOD
Systems).
Data Cache: Shared 512 MB predictive data cache (expandable to 2 GB);
Automatic write cache destaging; 72-hour battery backup (for 512 MB cache).
Command Queue Depth: 512 commands per VTrak system (up to 1024
commands with 512 MB memory).
Operational Features
RAID Levels: RAID 0, 1, 1E, 5, 6, 10, 50, and 60 – Any combination of these
RAID levels can exist at the same time.
Configurable RAID stripe size: 64 KB, 128 KB, 256 KB, 512 KB, and 1 MB stripe
size per logical drive.
Background task priority tuning: Adjustment of minimum I/O reserved for server
use during all background tasks.
Hot spares: Multiple global or dedicated hot-spare drives with revert option.
Maximum LUNs per subsystem: 256 in any combination of RAID levels.
Maximum LUNs per array: 32 logical drives (LUNs). Supports LUN carving by
allowing an array to be divided into multiple logical drives. Supports out-of-order
logical drive deletion and re-creation.
Max LUNs per Target ID: Up to 256, depending on host side driver and operating
system.
6
Chapter 1: Introduction to VTrak
LUN Masking and Mapping: Supports multiple hosts.
Disk Data Formats: Supports Disk Data Format (DDF) for industry-wide
standardization and drive roaming between VTrak systems.
Background Activities: Media Patrol, background synchronizing, disk array
rebuild, Redundancy Check, SMART condition pooling, Online Capacity
Expansion (OCE), RAID Level Migration (RLM). Includes priority control, rate
control, and watermarking per BGA in disk and NVRAM.
Foreground Activities: Disk array initialization.
Physical Drive Error Recovery: Predictive Data Migration (PDM), replaces unhealthy disk member in array, while maintaining normal array status during the
data transition. Bad Sector Mapping, Media Patrol, SMART, Hard/Soft Reset to
recover HD from bad status, HD Power-control to recover HD from hung status.
Array Error Recovery: Data recovery from bad sector or failed HD for redundant
RAID, RAID 5/6 inconsistent data Prevent (Write Hole Table), Data content Error
Prevent (Read/Write Check Table) NVRAM event logging.
SCSI Commands: Supports extensive SCSI command set equivalent to SCSI/FC
hard disk drives. Variable sector size (512 byte to 4 KB) to break OS 2TB
limitation. 16 byte CDB support for 64-bit LBA addressing.
Management
Supported Operating Systems: Windows 2000 Server, Windows 2003 Server,
Linux (Red Hat, SuSE), Macintosh OS X, Solaris.
Management Tools: WebPAM PROe via out-of-band Ethernet. OS independent,
localized in multiple languages, SSL Security support. Command Line Interface
(CLI) and Command Line Utility (CLU) via RJ-11 Serial Port or Telnet.
Standard Management Protocols: SNMP, WBEM/CIM
RAID Creation: Automatic, Express, and Advanced configuration support for
novice to skilled users.
Management Interfaces: WebPAM PROe, CLU, CLI, audible (buzzer) and visible
(LEDs) alarms.
Management Protocols: Embedded web server and management support—no
host agent needed. Ethernet, RJ-11 serial port, SNMP, SSL, Telnet, Email.
7
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Specifications
E610f and E610s
Voltage: 100–240 VAC Auto-ranging.
Current (maximum): 8 A @ 100 VAC or 4 A @ 240 VAC Current rating with two
power cords.
Power Consumption (not including disk drives): E610f, 142.12 W. E610s,
151.42 W.
Power Consumption (including disk drives): E610f, 562.65 W. E610s, 566.95 W.
Power Supply: Dual 500 W, 100-240 VAC auto-ranging, 50-60 Hz, dual hot swap
and redundant with PFC, N+1 design.
Operating Temperature: 5° to 40°C operational (-40° to 60°C non-operational)
Relative Humidity: Maximum 95 percent.
Vibration: Random, 0.21 grms, 5-500 Hz, 30 Mins, X, Y, Z axis.
Dimensions (H x W x D): 13.1 x 44.6 x 56.1 cm (5.2 x 17.6 x 22.1 in)
Net Weight: 30.5 kg (67.2 lb) without drives, 38.5 kg (84.9 lb) with 16 drives,
assuming 0.5 kg (1.1 lb) per drive.
Gross Weight (including carton): 37.5 kg (82.7 lb) without drives.
Safety: CE, FCC Class A, VCCI, C-Tick, cUL, TUV, CB, BSMI, MIC.
E310f and E310s
Voltage: 100–240 VAC Auto-ranging.
Current (maximum): 8 A @ 100 VAC or 4 A @ 240 VAC Current rating with two
power cords.
Power Consumption (not including disk drives): E310f, 141.68 W. E310s,
157.84 W.
Power Consumption (including disk drives): E310f, 453.32 W. E310s, 469.48 W.
Power Supply: Dual 400 W, 100-240 VAC auto-ranging, 50-60 Hz, dual hot swap
and redundant with PFC, N+1 design.
Operating Temperature: 5° to 40°C operational (-40° to 60°C non-operational)
Relative Humidity: Maximum 95 percent.
Vibration: Random, 0.21 grms, 5-500 Hz, 30 Mins, X, Y, Z axis.
8
Chapter 1: Introduction to VTrak
Dimensions (H x W x D): 8.8 x 44.4 x 56.1 cm (3.5 x 17.5 x 22.1 in)
Net Weight: 22 kg (49 lb) without drives, 28 kg (62 lb) with 12 drives, assuming
0.5 kg (1.1 lb) per drive.
Gross Weight (including carton): 30 kg (66 lb) without drives.
Safety: CE, FCC Class A, VCCI, C-Tick, cUL, TUV, CB, BSMI, MIC.
Warranty and Support
Warranty: Three years complete system limited warranty.
Support: 24x7 email and phone support (English only). 24x7 access to Promise
support site for drivers, firmware, and compatibility.
FCC Statement
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the
following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause harmful interference, and
(2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that
may cause undesired operation.
CE Statement
Warning: This is a class A product. In a domestic environment this product may
cause radio interference in which case the user may be required to take
adequate measures.
MIC Statement
9
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
10
Chapter 2: VTrak Installation
This chapter covers the following topics:
•
Unpacking the VTrak (below)
•
Mounting VTrak E610f/s in a Rack (page 12)
•
Mounting VTrak E310f/s in a Rack (page 14)
•
Installing Disk Drives (page 17)
•
Making Management and Data Connections (page 21)
•
Making Serial Cable Connections (page 32)
•
Connecting the Power (page 33)
Unpacking the VTrak
The VTrak box contains the following items:
•
VTrak Unit
•
RJ11-to-DB9 serial data cable
•
Quick Start Guide
•
•
Front bezel and key
•
Left and right center-mount
brackets
Screws for disk drives
(E610f/s: 70, including 6 spares)
(E310f/s: 50, including 2 spares)
•
1.5m (4.9 ft) Power cords (2)
•
Left and right mounting rails
•
CD with SNMP files, Product
Manual and Quick Start Guide
Warning
The electronic components within the VTrak disk array are
sensitive to damage from Electro-Static Discharge (ESD).
Observe appropriate precautions at all times when handling the
VTrak or its subassemblies.
Important
Use the following categories of network cables with VTrak:
•
Cat 6, preferred
•
Cat 5E, minimum
11
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Mounting VTrak E610f/s in a Rack
The E610f/s subsystem installs to the rack using the supplied mounting rails. You
can also use your existing rails.
Figure 1. VTrak E610f/s mounted in a rack with the supplied rails
Vertical Rack Post
VTrak E610f/s
Mounting rails (included)
mount outside the rack post
Handles mount
outside the rack post
Cautions
•
At least two persons are required to safely lift, place, and
attach the VTrak subsystem into a rack system.
•
Do not lift or move the VTrak subsystem by the handles,
power supplies or the controller units. Hold the subsystem
itself.
•
Do not install the VTrak subsystem into a rack without rails to
support the subsystem.
•
Only a qualified electrician who is familiar with the installation
procedure should mount and install the VTrak subsystem.
•
Be sure all switches are OFF before installing the VTrak
subsystem or exchanging components.
To install the E610f/s subsystem into a rack with the supplied mounting rails:
1.
Check the fit of the mounting rails in your rack system. See Figure 2.
2.
Adjust the length of the mounting rails as needed.
3.
Attach the mounting rail assemblies to the outside of the rack posts, using
the attaching screws from your rack system.
Be sure the support is on the bottom facing inward.
12
Chapter 2: VTrak Installation
4.
Square the rail assemblies in the rack.
5.
Tighten the adjustment screws and the attaching screws.
6.
Place the VTrak subsystem onto the rails.
7.
Secure the VTrak subsystem to the rack through each handle, using the
attaching screws from your rack system.
Figure 2. Rack mount assembly diagram
Rack front post
Rack back post
Rail attaching screw
(not included)
Rail attaching screw
(not included)
Front rail
Rear rail
Flange
Support
Rail adjustment screw
Rail adjustment screw
Inside of post
Inside of post
13
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Mounting VTrak E310f/s in a Rack
The E-Class subsytems installs to the rack using the supplied mounting rails. You
can also use your existing rails.
Figure 3. VTrak E310f/s mounted in a rack with the supplied rails
VTrak E310f/s
Vertical Rack Post
Handles mount
outside the rack post
Mounting rails (included)
mount outside the rack post
Cautions
•
At least two persons are required to safely lift, place, and
attach the VTrak subsystem into a rack system.
•
Do not lift or move the VTrak subsystem by the handles,
power supplies or the controller units. Hold the subsystem
itself.
•
Do not install the VTrak subsystem into a rack without rails to
support the subsystem.
•
Only a qualified electrician who is familiar with the installation
procedure should mount and install the VTrak subsystem.
•
Be sure all switches are OFF before installing the VTrak
subsystem or exchanging components.
To install the VTrak subsystem into a rack with the supplied mounting rails:
1.
Check the fit of the mounting rails in your rack system. See Figure 5.
2.
Slide the plates out of the mounting rails.
3.
Attach one plate to each side of the VTrak subsystem.
Line-up the six holes in the plate with the corresponding holes in the
subsystem. Attach each plate with six screws (included). See Figure 4.
4.
Slide one of the rails over the plate on one side of the enclosure.
14
Chapter 2: VTrak Installation
The rail is designed to slide freely over the plate.
5.
Attach a flange to each end of the rail, with the rail on the opposite side of the
flange from the two-hole bracket.
6.
Install the rail adjustment screws (included) through the flange into the rail.
There are four screws for each flange. See Figure 5.
7.
Place the subsystem with mounting rails into your rack system.
8.
Attach the mounting rail assemblies to the outside of the rack posts, using
the attaching screws from your rack system.
9.
Square the rail assemblies in the rack.
10. Tighten the adjustment screws and the attaching screws.
11. Place the VTrak subsystem onto the rails.
12. Secure the VTrak subsystem to the rack through each handle, using the
attaching screws from your rack system.
Figure 4. Sliding flange installation
Rear (connector end)
of the subsystem
VTrak E310f/s
Sliding plate
Screws (6 each
15
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Figure 5. Mounting rail installation
Rack front post
Rack back post
Rail adjustment screw
Mounting Rail
Sliding plate
Rail attaching screw
(not included)
Rail attaching screw
(not included)
Inside of post
Inside of post
16
Chapter 2: VTrak Installation
Installing Disk Drives
You can populate the VTrak with SAS or SATA hard disk drives. For optimal
performance, install physical drives of the same model and capacity. The drives’
matched performance allows the logical drive to function better as a single drive.
The table below shows the number of drives required for each RAID level.
Level
Number of Drives
Level
Number of Drives
RAID 0
1 or more
RAID 6
4 to 16*
RAID 1
2 only
RAID 10
4 or more**
RAID 1E
2 or more
RAID 50
6 or more
RAID 5
3 to 16*
RAID 60
8 or more
* E310f/s: Drive counts above 12 require an expansion unit.
** Must be an even number of drives.
Drive Slot Numbering
You can install any suitable disk drive into any slot in the enclosure. The diagram
below shows how VTrak’s drive slots are numbered. Slot numbering is reflected
in the WebPAM PROe and CLU user interfaces.
Figure 6. VTrak E610f/s drive slot numbering
1
2
5
9
3
6
10
13
4
8
7
11
12
15
14
17
16
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Figure 7. VTrak E310f/s drive slot numbering
1
2
9
4
3
5
6
8
7
10
11
12
Install all of the drive carriers into the VTrak enclosure to ensure proper airflow,
even if you do not populate all the carriers with disk drives.
AAMUX Adapter
If your VTrak has dual controllers—Fibre Channel or SAS—and you plan to
install SATA drives, you must install an AAMUX adapter with each SATA drive.
AAMUX adapters are available from Promise Technology.
Installing Disk Drives
1.
Remove a disk drive carrier.
2.
SATA drives only. Place the AAMUX adapter into the disk drive carrier and
attach it with the four screws. See Figure 9.
3.
•
Install only the screws supplied with the adapter.
•
The adapter fits into the carrier with the SAS connector at the back.
•
Snug each screw. Be careful not to over tighten.
Carefully lay the disk drive into the drive carrier at the front, so that the screw
holes on the bottom line up.
If you installed an AAMUX adapter, lay the SATA disk drive into the carrier
and slide it so the power and data connectors insert in to the adapter.
4.
5.
Insert the screws through the holes in the drive carrier and into the bottom of
the disk drive. See Figure 8.
•
Install only the counter-sink screws supplied with the VTrak.
•
Install four screws per drive.
•
Snug each screw. Be careful not to over-tighten.
Reinstall the drive carrier into the VTrak chassis.
Repeat steps 2 through 5 until all of your disk drives are installed.
18
Chapter 2: VTrak Installation
Figure 8. Disk drive mounting holes in the drive carrier
Counter-sink screws only.
Disk drive mounting holes
with AAMUX
WARNING:
AAMUX adapter
mounting holes
Drive mounting holes
without AAMUX
Figure 9. SATA drive mounted in a drive carrier with the AAMUX adapter
SATA disk drive
AAMUX adapter
19
SAS connector
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Figure 10.SAS drive mounted in a drive carrier
SAS disk drive
20
Chapter 2: VTrak Installation
Making Management and Data Connections
For Serial Attached SCSI setup, go to page 26.
Fibre Channel
VTrak models can have one or two RAID controllers. Each controller has an
Ethernet (RJ45) Management Port connector that enables you to monitor the
VTrak over your network using the WebPAM PROe Software. VTrak supports
HTTP(S) and Telnet protocols.
The VTrak E610f and E310f RAID controllers have two 4-Gb Fibre Channel (FC)
connections for the data ports. See Figure 11.
You can configure your VTrak for:
•
Storage Area Network (SAN)
•
Direct Attached Storage (DAS)
•
JBOD Expansion using a SAS data connection
Figure 11. VTrak E610f and E310f controller data and management
connectors
Fibre Channel data port 1
Fibre Channel data port 2
Mgmt
FC 1
4
FC 2
2
UPS
4
2
1
1
Gb/s
Gb/s
SAS expansion
port (to JBOD)
115200
8N1
Management port
Configuring a Storage Area Network
A storage area network (SAN) requires:
•
A Fibre Channel switch
•
A Fibre Channel HBA card in each Host PC or Server
•
A network switch
•
A network interface card (NIC) in each Host PC or Server
To establish the data path:
On the VTrak controller, connect one of the Fibre Channel data ports to your
Fibre Channel switch.
21
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
To establish the management path:
1.
On the VTrak controller, connect the Management Port to your network
switch. Figure 12.
2.
Connect each Host PC’s or Server’s standard NIC to your network switch.
Figure 12.SAN data and management connections. The E310f is shown.
The E610f is similar
Network Switch
FC Switch
I
I
O
O
Mgmt
FC 1
4
2
FC 2
Mgmt
UPS
FC 1
4
1
Gb/s
4
2
2
1
Gb/s
115200
8N1
FC 2
UPS
4
2
1
1
Gb/s
Gb/s
115200
8N1
VTrak
Host PC or Server
Host PC or Server
Configuring Direct Attached Storage
Direct attached storage (DAS) requires:
•
Two Fibre Channel HBA cards in the Host PC or Server
•
A network switch
•
A network interface card (NIC) in the Host PC or Server
To establish the data path:
On the VTrak controller, connect one of the Fibre Channel data ports to your
Fibre Channel switch. See Figure 13.
To establish the management path:
1.
On the VTrak controller, connect the Management Port to your network
switch. See Figure 13.
2.
Connect the Host PC’s or Server’s standard NIC to your network switch.
22
Chapter 2: VTrak Installation
Figure 13.DAS data and management connections. The E310f is shown.
The E610f is similar
Network Switch
I
I
O
O
Mgmt
FC 1
4
2
FC 2
UPS
4
1
Gb/s
Mgmt
FC 1
4
2
2
1
Gb/s
115200
8N1
FC 2
UPS
4
2
1
1
Gb/s
Gb/s
115200
8N1
VTrak
Host PC or Server
23
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Configuring JBOD Expansion
To expand the number of disk drives:
1.
On the E610f or E310f controller, connect the SAS connector (a subtractiverouted port) to CN1 (a table-routed port) on the I/O module of the first J300s
unit. See Figure 14.
2.
Connect CN3 (a subtractive-routed port) on the first J300s unit to CN1 on
one of the I/O modules of the next J300s unit.
3.
Connect the remaining J300s units in the same manner.
Figure 14. JBOD data connections. The E310f is shown. The E610f is
similar
FC Switch
E310f
I
O
SAS Connector
Mgmt
FC 1
FC 2
4
2
UPS
4
2
1
1
Gb/s
Gb/s
115200
8N1
FC Connector
J300s
O
I
CN3
CN1
J300s
O
I
CN1
You can expand a SAN system with no single point of failure. See Figure 15.
Such an arrangement requires:
•
Two Fibre Channel switches
•
Two Fibre Channel HBA cards in each Host PC or Server
•
A network switch (not shown)
•
A network interface card (NIC) in each Host PC or Server
24
Chapter 2: VTrak Installation
Figure 15.JBOD expansion with no single point of failure
Host PCs or Servers
Fibre Channel Switches
I
I
O
O
E310f
Mgmt
FC 1
FC 2
4
2
J300s
J300s
J300s
J300s
Mgmt
UPS
FC 1
4
1
Gb/s
4
2
2
1
Gb/s
115200
8N1
FC 2
UPS
4
2
1
1
Gb/s
Gb/s
115200
8N1
O
O
I
I
O
O
I
I
O
O
I
I
O
O
I
I
25
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
This completes management and data connections for VTrak E610f and E310f.
Go to “Making Serial Cable Connections” on page 32.
Serial Attached SCSI
VTrak models can have one or two RAID controllers. Each controller has an
Ethernet (RJ45) Management Port connector that enables you to monitor the
VTrak over your network using the WebPAM PROe Software. VTrak supports
HTTP(S) and Telnet protocols.
The standard VTrak E610s and E310s controllers have five SAS ports:
•
Data ports (2) – Connects to the Host PC or Server
•
Data/Cascade ports (2) – Connects to the data port of a second E310s
controller or to the Host PC or Server
•
SAS Expansion port (1) – Connects to a VTrak J300s JBOD expansion
subsystem
You can configure your VTrak for:
•
Direct Attached Storage (DAS)
•
Cascaded Storage (Multiple E610s or E310s subsystems)
•
JBOD Expansion using a SAS data connection
Figure 16. VTrak E610s and E310s controller data and management
connectors
SAS data port
SAS data/cascade port
Mgmt
UPS
115200
8N1
SAS expansion
port (to JBOD)
Management port
SAS data/cascade port
SAS data port
26
Chapter 2: VTrak Installation
Configuring Direct Attached Storage
Direct attached storage (DAS) requires:
•
Two SAS HBA cards in the Host PC or Server
•
A network switch
•
A network interface card (NIC) in the Host PC or Server
To establish the data path:
On the VTrak controller, connect a SAS data port or a SAS data/cascade port to
one of your SAS HBA cards. See Figure 17.
To establish the management path:
1.
On the VTrak controller, connect the Management Port on each Controller to
your network switch. See Figure 17.
2.
Connect the Host PC’s or Server’s standard NIC to your network switch.
Figure 17. DAS data and management connections. The E310s is shown.
The E610s is similar
Network Switch
I
I
O
O
Mgmt
UPS
115200
8N1
Mgmt
UPS
115200
8N1
VTrak
Host PC or Server
27
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Configuring Cascaded Storage
Cascaded storage requires:
•
One SAS HBA card in the Host PC or Server
•
A network switch
•
A network interface card (NIC) in the Host PC or Server
To establish the data path:
1.
On the VTrak controller, connect a SAS data port or a SAS data/cascade
port to your SAS HBA card. See Figure 18.
2.
Connect the data/cascade port (a subtractive-routed port) of the first E610s
or E310s to the data port (a table-routed port) on the second E310s.
3.
Connect the remaining E610s or E310s controllers in the same manner.
You can cascade up to eight VTrak subsystems.
To establish the management path:
1.
On the VTrak controller, connect the Management Port on each Controller to
your network switch. See Figure 19.
2.
Connect the Host PC’s or Server’s standard NIC to your network switch.
Figure 18. Cascaded data connections. The E310s is shown. The E610s is
similar
Host PC or Server
I
O
E310s
Mgmt
SAS data port
I
Mgmt
SAS data port
UPS
115200
8N1
I
O
E310s
SAS data/
cascade port
O
E310s
UPS
115200
8N1
Mgmt
SAS data port
UPS
115200
8N1
28
SAS data/
cascade port
Chapter 2: VTrak Installation
Figure 19.Cascaded management and data connections. The E310s is
shown. The E610s is similar
Network Switch
I
I
O
O
Mgmt
UPS
115200
8N1
VTrak
I
I
O
Host PC or Server
O
Mgmt
UPS
115200
8N1
VTrak
I
I
O
O
Mgmt
UPS
115200
8N1
VTrak
29
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Configuring JBOD Expansion
To expand the number of disk drives:
1.
On the E610s or E310s controller, connect the SAS expansion port (a
subtractive-routed port) to the CN1 (a table-routed port) on one of the I/O
modules of the first J300s unit. See Figure 20.
2.
Connect CN3 (a subtractive-routed port) on the first J300s unit to CN1 on
one of the I/O modules of the next J300s unit.
3.
Connect the remaining J300s units in the same manner.
Figure 20.JBOD data connections. The E310s is shown. The E610s is
similar
Host PC or Server
E310s
I
O
SAS expansion
port
Mgmt
UPS
115200
8N1
SAS data port
J300s
O
I
CN1
CN3
J300s
O
I
CN1
You can expand a SAN system with no single point of failure. See Figure 21.
Such an arrangement requires:
•
Two SAS HBA cards in each Host PC or Server
•
A network switch (not shown)
•
A network interface card (NIC) in each Host PC or Server
•
One to four VTrak J300s JBOD subsystems
30
Chapter 2: VTrak Installation
Figure 21. JBOD expansion with no single point of failure
Host PCs or Servers
I
I
O
O
E310s
Mgmt
Mgmt
UPS
115200
8N1
J300s
J300s
J300s
J300s
UPS
115200
8N1
O
O
I
I
O
O
I
I
O
O
I
I
O
O
I
I
This completes Network and Data connections for VTrak E610s and E310s. Go
to “Making Serial Cable Connections” on page 32.
31
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Making Serial Cable Connections
RS232 serial communication enables the Command Line Interface (CLI) and
Command Line Utility (CLU) on your PC to monitor and control the VTrak. On
VTrak, RS232 communication goes through the RJ11 serial connector on each
controller.
Figure 22. Serial communication goes through the RJ11 connector. The
E310f is shown. The E610f, E610s, and E310s are similar
RJ11 Serial
Connector
Mgmt
UPS
115200
8N1
I
I
O
O
Mgmt
FC 1
4
2
FC 2
UPS
4
2
1
1
Gb/s
Gb/s
Mgmt
FC 1
4
2
115200
8N1
FC 2
UPS
4
2
1
1
Gb/s
Gb/s
115200
8N1
To set up a serial cable connection:
1.
Attach the RJ11 end of the RJ11-to-DB9 serial data cable, supplied with the
VTrak, to the RJ11 serial connector on one of the controllers.
2.
Attach a null-modem cable to the DB9 end of the RJ11-to-DB9 serial data
cable.
3.
Attach the other end of the null-modem cable to a serial port on the Host PC
or Server.
Note
The DB9 connector on the VTrak controller is for a UPS support,
which is planned for a future release.
32
Chapter 2: VTrak Installation
Connecting the Power
Plug the power cords and switch on both power supplies on. When the power is
switched on, the LEDs on the front of the VTrak will light up.
Figure 23.VTrak front panel LED display. The E310f/s display is shown. The
E610f/s display is similar
Power
FRU Status
Logical Drive Status
Controller-1 Activity
Controller-2 Activity
Controller Heartbeat
When boot-up is finished and the VTrak is functioning normally:
•
Controller LED blinks green once per second for five seconds, goes dark for
ten seconds, then blinks green once per second for five seconds again.
•
Power, FRU and Logical Drive LEDs display green continuously.
•
Controller LEDs flash green if there is activity on that controller.
There are two LEDs on each disk drive carrier. They report the presence of
power and a disk drive, and the current condition of the drive.
Figure 24.VTrak disk drive carrier LEDs
Disk Status
Power/Activity
After a few moments the Power/Activity LED should display Green. If there is no
disk drive in the carrier, the Power/Activity LED will remain dark.
33
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
The Power/Activity LED flashes during drive activity.
The Disk Status LED displays Green when a drive is present and configured.
Go to “Chapter 3: VTrak Setup” on page 35.
34
Chapter 3: VTrak Setup
This chapter covers the following topics:
•
Setting up the Serial Connection (below)
•
Choosing DHCP or a Static IP Address (page 36)
•
Setting up VTrak with the CLI (page 37)
•
Setting up VTrak with the CLU (page 39)
•
Creating Disk Arrays with WebPAM PROe (page 42)
Setting up the Serial Connection
VTrak has a Command Line Interface (CLI) to manage all of its functions,
including customization. A subset of the CLI is the Command Line Utility (CLU), a
user-level interface that manages your VTrak via your PC’s terminal emulation
program, such as Microsoft HyperTerminal. This procedure uses the serial cable
connection you made. See “Making Serial Cable Connections” on page 32.
1.
2.
Change your terminal emulation program settings to match the following
specifications:
•
Bits per second: 115200
•
Data bits: 8
•
Parity: None
•
Stop bits: 1
•
Flow control: none
Start your PC’s terminal VT100 or ANSI emulation program.
3.
Press Enter once to launch the CLI.
4.
At the Login prompt, type administrator and press Enter.
5.
At the Password prompt, type password and press Enter.
At this point, you are in the CLI. You can continue using the CLI to make
network settings or you can switch to the CLU. Go to:
•
Setting up VTrak with the CLI (page 37)
•
Setting up VTrak with the CLU (page 39)
35
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Choosing DHCP or a Static IP Address
When you setup your VTrak, you have the option of:
•
Enabling DHCP and letting your DHCP server assign the IP address to the
VTrak’s virtual management port.
•
Specifying a static IP address for the VTrak’s virtual management port.
If you choose to enable DHCP, have your Network Administrator dedicate an IP
address for the VTrak, linked to the VTrak’s MAC address. This action will
prevent the DHCP server from assigning a new IP address when the VTrak
restarts, with the result that users can no longer log in.
To access the MAC address for VTrak’s virtual management port:
•
In the CLI, type net -v and press Enter.
•
In the CLU Main Menu, highlight Network Management and press Enter.
Then highlight Virtual and press Enter.
36
Chapter 3: Setup
Setting up VTrak with the CLI
1.
Type the following string to set the system date and time, then press Enter.
administrator@cli> date -a mod -d 2006/08/25 -t 14:50:05
In the above example, the date and time are included as examples only.
Your values will be different. Use yyyyy/mm/dd for the date and a 24-hour
clock for the time.
2.
Type the following string to set the Management Port IP address and other
settings, then press Enter.
administrator@cli> net -a mod -t mgmt -s "primaryip=192.168.10.85,
primaryipmask=255.255.255.0, gateway=192.168.10.1"
In the above example, the IP addresses and subnet mask are included as
examples only. Your values will be different.
If you prefer to let your DHCP server assign the IP address, type the
following string, then press Enter.
administrator@cli> net -a mod -t mgmt -s "dhcp=enable"
Note that the IP address described above belongs to the VTrak subsystem,
not to the RAID controller. Use this IP address to log into the VTrak over your
network.
3.
To verify the settings, type net and press Enter.
administrator@cli> net
===========================================
CId Port Type IP
Mask
Gateway
Link
===========================================
Virtual
Mgmt 192.168.10.85 255.255.255.0 192.168.10.1 Up
Each RAID controller has an IP addresses for access when the controller
goes into maintenance mode. Maintenance mode is only for remedial action
in the event of a problem with the controller. See “Controller Enters
Maintenance Mode” on page 298 for more information.
4.
Type the following string to set the Maintenance Mode IP address and other
settings, then press Enter. You must set each controller separately.
administrator@cli> net -a mod -t mgmt -m -c 1 -s
"primaryip=192.168.10.101, primaryipmask=255.255.255.0,
gateway=192.168.10.1"
administrator@cli> net -a mod -t mgmt -m -c 2 -s
"primaryip=192.168.10.102, primaryipmask=255.255.255.0,
gateway=192.168.10.1"
37
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
In the above example, the IP addresses and subnet mask are included as
examples only. Your values will be different.
If you prefer to let your DHCP server assign the IP addresses, type the
following strings, then press Enter.
administrator@cli> net -a mod -t mgmt -m -c 1 -s "dhcp=enable"
administrator@cli> net -a mod -t mgmt -m -c 2 -s "dhcp=enable"
Note that the IP address described above belongs to the RAID controller, not
to the VTrak subsystem. Use this IP address to log into the controller over
your network.
5.
To verify the maintenance mode settings, type net -m and press Enter.
administrator@cli> net -m
––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
CtrlId: 1
Port: 1
Type: Management Ethernet
IPType: IPv4
IP: 192.168.10.101
IPMask: 255.255.255.0
MAC: 00:01:55:AE:02:AE
DNS: 0.0.0.0
Gateway: 192.168.10.1
DHCP: Disabled
This completes the Management port setup. Go to “Creating Disk Arrays with
WebPAM PROe” on page 42.
To see the full set of CLI commands, at the admin@cli> prompt, type help and
press Enter.
38
Chapter 3: Setup
Setting up VTrak with the CLU
1.
At the administrator@cli> prompt, type menu and press Enter.
The CLU main menu appears.
Figure 1. CLU main menu
2.
With Quick Setup highlighted, press Enter.
The first Quick Setup screen enables you to make Date and Time settings.
Setting system date and time
1.
Press the arrow keys to highlight System Date.
2.
Press the backspace key to erase the current date.
3.
Type the new date.
4.
Follow the same procedure to set the System Time.
5.
Press Ctrl-A to save these settings and move to the Management Port
configuration screen.
Making Management Port settings
By default, DHCP is disabled on VTrak and the default Management Port IP
address is set to 10.0.0.2.
Note that the IP address described here belongs to the VTrak subsystem, not to
the RAID controller. Use this IP address to log into the VTrak over your network.
Manual IP settings
To make Management Port settings manually:
1.
Press the arrow keys to highlight IP Address.
39
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
2.
Press the backspace key to erase the current IP Address.
3.
Type the new IP Address.
4.
Follow the same procedure to specify the Subnet Mask, Gateway IP
Address and DNS Server IP Address.
If you do not have a DNS server, skip the DNS Server IP address.
5.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
Automatic IP settings
To make Management Port settings automatically:
1.
Press the arrow keys to highlight DHCP.
2.
Press the spacebar to toggle to Enable.
3.
Press Ctrl-A to save these settings.
Viewing IP address and settings
To view the current IP address and network settings when using DHCP:
1.
Press the arrow keys to highlight DHCP.
2.
Press the spacebar to toggle to Disable.
The current Management Port settings are displayed.
3.
Press the spacebar to toggle DHCP back to Enable.
4.
Press Ctrl-A to save these settings and move to the RAID configuration
screen.
Making Controller Maintenance Mode Settings
Each RAID controller has an IP addresses for access when the controller goes
into maintenance mode. Maintenance mode is only for remedial action in the
event of a problem with the controller. See “Controller Enters Maintenance Mode”
on page 298 for more information.
Note that the IP address described here belongs to the RAID controller, not to the
VTrak subsystem. Use this IP address to log into the controller over your
network.
Making Automatic Settings
1.
From the CLU Main Menu, highlight Network Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Maintenance Mode Network Configuration and press Enter.
3.
Highlight the controller you want and press Enter.
4.
Highlight DHCP and press the spacebar to toggle to Enabled.
5.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
40
Chapter 3: Setup
Making Manual Settings
1.
From the CLU Main Menu, highlight Network Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Maintenance Mode Network Configuration and press Enter.
3.
Highlight the controller you want and press Enter.
4.
Highlight DHCP and press the spacebar to toggle to Disabled.
5.
Highlight each of the following and press the backspace key to erase the
current value, then type the new value.
6.
•
IP Address
•
Subnet Mask
•
Default Gateway IP Address
•
DNS Server IP Address
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
Exiting the CLU
1.
Highlight Skip the Step and Finish and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Return to CLI and press Enter.
This completes the Management Port setup. Go to “Creating Disk Arrays with
WebPAM PROe” on page 42.
41
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Creating Disk Arrays with WebPAM PROe
Note
You can also use the CLU to create disk arrays and logical drives.
See Chapter 5 of the VTrak E-Class Product Manual for more
information.
Setting up disk arrays with WebPAM PROe consists of the following actions:
•
Logging into WebPAM PROe (below)
•
Selecting a Language (page 44)
•
Creating a Disk Array (page 44)
•
Logging out of WebPAM PROe (page 48)
•
Using WebPAM PROe over the Internet (page 49)
•
Obtaining a Security Certificate (page 49)
Logging into WebPAM PROe
1.
Launch your Browser.
2.
In the Browser address field, type in the IP address of the VTrak subsystem.
Use the IP address you set in the CLI (page 37) or CLU (page 39). Note that
the IP address shown below is only an example. The IP address you type
into your browser will be different.
Regular Connection
•
WebPAM PROe uses an HTTP connection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .http://
•
Enter the VTrak’s Management Port IP address . . . . 192.168.10.85
Together, your entry looks like this:
http://192.168.10.85
Secure Connection
•
WebPAM PROe uses a secure HTTP connection . . . . . . . . . .https://
•
Enter the VTrak’s Management Port IP address . . . . 192.168.10.85
Together, your entry looks like this:
https://192.168.10.85
Note
Whether you select a regular or a secure connection, your login to
WebPAM PROe and your user password are always secure.
42
Chapter 3: Setup
3.
When the log-in screen (Figure 2) appears:
•
Type administrator in the User Name field.
•
Type password in the Password field.
•
Click the Login button.
The User Name and Password are case sensitive.
4.
Click the Login button.
Figure 2. WebPAM PROe log-in screen
After sign-in, the WebPAM PROe opening screen appears. If there are any
unconfigured physical drives in the enclosure, an Array Configuration menu will
also appear (see page 44).
Note
Make a Bookmark (Netscape Navigator) or set a Favorite (Internet
Explorer) of the Login Screen so you can access it easily next
time.
43
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Selecting a Language
WebPAM PROe displays in English, German, French, Italian, Japanese, Chinese
Traditional, Chinese Simple, and Korean.
1.
Click Language on the WebPAM PROe Header.
The language list appears in the Header.
2.
Click on the language you prefer.
The WebPAM PROe user interface displays in the selected language.
Figure 3. Clicking “Language” on the WebPAM PROe Header
Creating a Disk Array
On a newly activated VTrak subsystem, there are no disk arrays or logical drives.
To create a disk array:
1.
Click on the Disk Arrays
icon, then click on the Create tab.
The Array Configuration menu appears. See Figure 4.
2.
3.
Choose one of the options:
•
Automatic – Creates a new disk array based on a default set of
parameters, including one logical drive. The number of unconfigured
physical drives available determines the RAID level of the disk array
and whether a spare drive is created. See page 45.
•
Express – Creates a new disk array based on the characteristics you
specify. You can create multiple logical drives. However, all of the logical
drives will be the same size and RAID level. See page 46.
•
Advanced – Enables you to directly specify all parameters for a new
disk array and its logical drives. See page 47.
Click the Next button.
Figure 4. The Array Configuration menu
44
Chapter 3: Setup
Automatic
When you choose the Automatic option, the following parameters appear on the
screen:
•
Disk Arrays – The number of physical drives in the disk array, their ID
numbers, configurable capacity, and the number of logical drives to be
created
•
Logical Drives – The ID number of the logical drive(s), their RAID level,
capacity, and stripe size
•
Spare Drives – The physical drive slot number of the dedicated hot spare
assigned to this disk array. A hot spare drive is created for all RAID levels
except RAID 0, when five or more unconfigured physical drives are available
If you accept these parameters, click the Submit button.
The new disk array appears in the Disk Array List on the Information tab.
If you do NOT accept these parameters, use the Express (page 46) or Advanced
(page 47) option to create your disk array.
45
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Express
When you choose the Express option, a set of characteristics and options
appears on the screen.
1.
2.
Check the boxes to select any one or a combination of:
•
Redundancy – The array will remain available if a physical drive fails
•
Capacity – The greatest possible amount of data capacity
•
Performance – The highest possible read/write speed
•
Spare Drive – A hot spare drive is created when you select
Redundancy, Spare Drive, and five or more unconfigured physical
drives are available
In the Number of Logical Drives field, enter the number of logical drives you
want to make from this disk array.
The maximum possible number of logical drives appears to the right of this
field.
3.
4.
From the Application Type menu, select an application that best describes
your intended use for this disk array:
•
File Server
•
Video Stream
•
Transaction Data
•
Transaction Log
•
Other
Click the Update button.
Or check the Automatic Update box and updates will occur automatically.
The following parameters display:
•
Disk Arrays – The number of physical drives in the disk array, their ID
numbers, configurable capacity, and the number of logical drives to be
created
•
Logical Drives – The ID number of the logical drive(s), their RAID level,
capacity, and stripe size
•
Spare Drives – The physical drive ID number of the dedicated hot spare
assigned to this disk array (all RAID levels except RAID 0)
If you accept these parameters, proceed to the next step.
If you do NOT accept these parameters, review and modify your selections
in the previous steps.
5.
When you are done, click the Submit button.
The new disk array appears in the Disk Array List on the Information tab.
46
Chapter 3: Setup
Advanced
Note
For an explanation of the parameters under the Advanced option,
see “Chapter 7: Technology Background” on page 231.
When you choose the Advanced option, the Step 1 – Disk Array Creation screen
displays.
Step 1 – Disk Array Creation
1.
Enter a name for the disk array in the field provided.
2.
Check the box if you want to enable Media Patrol.
For more information, see “Media Patrol” on page 255.
3.
Check the box if you want to enable PDM.
For more information, see “Predictive Data Migration (PDM)” on page 256.
4.
Highlight physical drives you want in the disk array from the Available list
and press the >> button to move them to the Selected list.
You can also double-click them to move them.
5.
When you are done, click the Next button.
Step 2 – Logical Drive Creation
Logical Drive Creation enables you to specify logical drives under the new disk
array. Enter the information for a logical drive, then click the Update button. If
there is free capacity remaining, you can specify another logical drive now or wait
until later.
6.
Enter an alias for the logical drive in the field provided.
7.
Choose a RAID level for the logical drive from the dropdown menu.
The choice of RAID levels depends the number of physical drives you
selected.
8.
RAID 50 and 60 only – Specify the number of axles for your array.
For more information on axles, see “RAID 50 Axles” on page 238 or “RAID
60 Axles” on page 240.
9.
Specify a Capacity and the unit of measure (MB, GB, TB).
This value will be the data capacity of the first logical drive in your new disk
array. If you specify less than disk array's maximum capacity, the remainder
will be available for additional logical drives which you can create later.
10. Specify a Stripe size from the dropdown menu.
64 KB, 128 KB, 256 KB, and 1 MB are available. 64 KB is the default.
11. Specify a Sector size from the dropdown menu.
47
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
512 B, 1 KB, 2 KB, and 4 KB are available. 512 B is the default.
12. Specify a Read (cache) Policy from the dropdown menu.
Read Cache, Read Ahead Cache, and No Cache are available. Read Ahead
is the default.
13. Specify a Write (cache) Policy from the dropdown menu.
Write Back and Write Through (Thru) are available. Write Back is the default.
14. From the Preferred Controller ID dropdown menu, select a controller.
The choices are Controller 1 or 2, or Automatic. This feature is only available
on subsystems with two controllers and LUN Affinity enabled.
15. Click the Update button.
A new logical drive is displayed under New Logical Drives.
Repeat the above steps to specify additional logical drives as desired.
16. When you are done specifying logical drives, click the Next button.
Step 3 – Summary
The Summary lists the disk array and logical drive information you specified.
17. To proceed with disk array and logical drive creation, click the Submit
button.
Logging out of WebPAM PROe
There are two ways to log out of WebPAM PROe:
•
Close your browser window
•
Click Logout on the WebPAM PROe banner
Figure 5. Clicking “Logout” on the WebPAM PROe banner
Clicking Logout brings you back to the Login Screen. See page 43.
After logging out, you must enter your user name and password in order to log in
again.
48
Chapter 3: Setup
Using WebPAM PROe over the Internet
The above instructions cover connections between VTrak and your company
network. It is also possible to connect to a VTrak from the Internet.
Your MIS Administrator can tell you how to access your network from outside the
firewall. Once you are logged onto the network, you can access the VTrak using
its IP address.
While only a Fibre Channel or SAS-capable PC can read and write data to the
logical drives on the VTrak, other PCs can monitor the VTrak from virtually any
location.
Obtaining a Security Certificate
Promise Technology provides a default security certificate for the web server as
well as for internal data communication. However, in most cases it is better to
install and verify your own certificate. And, if possible, verify your certificate
through a certificate authority, such as Verisign or Thwate. See your MIS
Administrator for guidance.
To download your security certificate to WebPAM PROe, see “Making Web
Server Settings” on page 91.
49
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
50
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
This chapter covers the following topics:
•
Logging into WebPAM PROe
(page 52)
•
Importing a User Database
(page 99)
•
Selecting a Language (page 54)
•
Updating the Firmware (page 100)
•
Perusing the Interface (page 55)
•
•
Logging out of WebPAM PROe
(page 59)
Restoring Factory Defaults
(page 101)
•
Clearing Statistics (page 102)
•
Working with the Storage Network
(page 60)
•
Shutting Down the Subsystem
(page 103)
•
Working with Subsystems (page 61)
•
•
Managing Users (page 72)
Restarting the Subsystem
(page 104)
•
Managing the Network Connection
(page 77)
•
Managing Controllers (page 105)
•
Managing Enclosures (page 110)
•
Managing Fibre Channel Connections •
(page 79)
Managing Physical Drives
(page 116)
•
Managing SAS Connections
(page 84)
•
Managing Disk Arrays (page 121)
•
Managing Logical Drives (page 134)
•
•
•
Managing Storage Services (page 87) •
Managing Software Services
•
(page 90)
Managing Spare Drives (page 141)
Working with the Logical Drive
Summary (page 145)
Exporting the User Database
(page 98)
For information about VTrak’s audible alarm and LEDs, see “Chapter 8:
Troubleshooting” on page 261.
51
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Logging into WebPAM PROe
In order to log into WebPAM PROe, you must first setup a network connection
between your Host PC and the VTrak subsystem, as described in “Chapter 3:
VTrak Setup” on page 35.
To log into WebPAM PROe:
1.
Launch your Browser.
2.
In the Browser address field, type in the IP address of the VTrak
Management port.
Note that the IIP address shown below is only an example. The IP address
you type into your browser will be different.
Regular Connection
•
WebPAM PROe uses an HTTP connection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .http://
•
Enter the VTrak’s Management Port IP address . . . . 192.168.10.85
Together, your entry looks like this:
http://192.168.10.85
Secure Connection
•
WebPAM PROe uses a secure HTTP connection . . . . . . . . . .https://
•
Enter the VTrak’s Management Port IP address . . . . 192.168.10.85
Together, your entry looks like this:
https://192.168.10.85
Note
Whether you select a regular or a secure connection, your login to
WebPAM PROe and your user password are always secure.
3.
When the log-in screen (Figure 1) appears:
•
Type administrator in the User Name field.
•
Type password in the Password field.
•
Click the Login button.
The User Name and Password are case sensitive.
4.
Click the Login button.
52
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Figure 1. The WebPAM PROe log-in screen
53
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Selecting a Language
WebPAM PROe displays in English, German, French, Italian, Japanese, Chinese
Traditional, Chinese Simple, and Korean.
1.
Click Language the WebPAM PROe Header.
The language list appears in the Header.
2.
Click the language you prefer.
The WebPAM PROe user interface displays in the selected language.
Figure 2. Clicking “Language” in the Header
54
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Perusing the Interface
WebPAM PROe is browser-based RAID management software with a graphic
user interface.
Figure 3. WebPAM PROe interface
There are four major parts to the graphic user interface:
•
Header (see page 56)
•
Tree (see page 57)
•
Management View (see page 58)
•
Event Frame (see page 58)
55
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Using the Header
The Header contains the following items:
•
Language – To change languages, see “Selecting a Language” on page 54.
•
View – To view the Event Frame, see “Viewing the Event Frame” on
page 58.
•
Storage Network – To view all of the VTrak subsystem enclosures currently
accessible the network, see “Working with the Storage Network” on page 60.
•
Contact Us – Click on Contact Us for a list of contact information, including
Technical Support. Also see “Contacting Technical Support” on page 305.
•
Logout – To logout of WebPAM PROe, see “Logging out of WebPAM PROe”
on page 59
•
Help – Click on Help in the Header to access the main online help menu.
•
About – Click on About in the Header to display the WebPAM PROe
software version and build date.
56
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Using Tree View
Tree View enables you to navigate around all components of the Subsystem,
including Fibre Channel or SAS management, network and service management,
RAID controller, enclosure, physical drives, disk arrays, logical drives, and spare
drives. The figure below shows the components of Tree View.
Figure 4. WebPAM PROe Tree View
Name of logged-in user
Subsystem IP address and model
Fibre Channel or SAS Management
Physical Drives
in this Enclosure
The Administrative Tools section is different for the Super User than for other
users. The remainder of the Tree is the same for all users.
Management View displays information according to the item you select in Tree
View.
57
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Using Management View
Management View provides the actual user interface with the VTrak, including
creation, maintenance, deletion, and monitoring of disk arrays and logical drives.
Function Tabs control specific actions and processes. This window changes
depending on which item you select in Tree View and which tab you select in
Management View itself.
Click the Help button in Management View to access online help for the function
that is currently displayed.
Viewing the Event Frame
To view the Event Frame:
1.
Click on View in the Header.
2.
Click the Show Event Frame popup option.
The VTrak user interface will display the Event Frame below Management
View.
3.
Click View again to hide the Event Frame.
In the event frame, events are listed and sorted by:
•
Item Number – A consecutive decimal number assigned to a specific event
•
Device – Battery, controller, logical drive, physical drive, port, etc.
•
Event ID – The hexadecimal number that identifies the specific type of event
•
Severity – Information, Warning, Minor, Major, Critical, and Fatal. The
severity level is user-specified. See “Setting-up User Event Subscriptions”
on page 73.
•
Time – Time and date of the occurrence
•
Description – A brief description of the event
Sorting Events
You can sort the events by Item Number, Device, Event ID, Severity, Time and
Date, or Description.
Click on the link at the top of the column by which you want to sort the events.
After you click on the item, a triangle icon appears.
•
If the triangle points upward, the column is sorted low-to-high or old-to-new.
•
If the triangle points downward, the column is sorted high-to-low or new-toold.
Click the link a second time to change to flip the triangle and reverse the sort
sequence.
58
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Logging out of WebPAM PROe
There are two ways to log out of WebPAM PROe:
•
Close your browser window
•
Click Logout the WebPAM PROe banner (below
Figure 8. Clicking “Logout” in the Header)
Clicking Logout brings you back to the Login Screen. After logging out, you must
enter your user name and password in order to log in again.
59
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Working with the Storage Network
When you log into WebPAM PROe, you access a specific VTrak subsystem. See
“Logging into WebPAM PROe” on page 52.
The Storage Network feature enables you to access all of the VTrak subsytems
with a Management Port connection to your network.
Each VTrak subsystem is identified by its Management Port IP address.
Storage Network functions include:
•
Viewing other subsystems
•
Updating the list of subsystems
•
Logging into a subsystem
•
Hiding the other subsystems
Viewing Other Subsytems
To view the other VTrak subsytems the Storage Network:
1.
2.
Click on Storage Network in the Header.
Click the Show Network Subsystems popup option.
The list will show all subsystems the network at the time the GUI was
launched.
Updating the List of Subsystems
To update the list of the VTrak subsytems the Storage Network:
Click the Discover button at the bottom of the subsystem list.
Logging into a Subsystem
To log into any of the displayed VTrak subsystems:
1.
In Tree View, click the Subsystem
icon of the subsystem you want to see.
If your user name and password do not match the subsystem you are
logging into, the log in screen will appear.
2.
Log into the new subsystem, as needed.
Hiding the Other Subsystems
To hide the other VTrak subsystems the Storage Network:
1.
Click on Storage Network in the Header.
2.
Click the Hide Network Subsystems popup option.
60
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Working with Subsystems
A VTrak subsystem is identified by its Management Port IP address. Subsystem
functions include:
•
Viewing Subsystem Information (page 61)
•
Saving Subsystem Configuration (page 62)
•
Setting an Alias for the Subsystem (page 62)
•
Setting Redundancy for the Subsystem (page 62)
•
Setting Cache Mirroring for the Subsystem (page 62)
•
Setting Subsystem Date and Time (page 63)
•
Viewing the Runtime Event Log (page 63)
•
Saving the Runtime Event Log (page 64)
•
Clearing the Runtime Event Log (page 64)
•
Viewing NVRAM Events (page 65)
•
Saving NVRAM Events (page 65)
•
Clearing NVRAM Events (page 66)
•
Viewing Current Background Activities (page 66)
•
Making Background Activity Settings (page 66)
•
Running Background Activities (page 67)
•
Running Media Patrol (page 68)
•
Running PDM (page 68)
•
Viewing Scheduled Activities (page 68)
•
Scheduling an Activity (page 69)
•
Deleting a Scheduled Activity (page 70)
•
Viewing Lock Status (page 70)
•
Setting the Lock (page 70)
•
Renewing the Lock (page 71)
•
Releasing the Lock (page 71)
Viewing Subsystem Information
To view information about a subsystem, click the Subsystem
View. Management View displays the subsystem information.
61
icon in Tree
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Saving Subsystem Configuration
To save the subsystem's configuration and status information to text file on your
Host PC:
1.
In Tree View, click the Subsystem
2.
On the Information tab, click the Save button.
icon.
3.
Direct your browser where to save the configuration and status file.
Setting an Alias for the Subsystem
An alias is optional. To set an alias for this subsystem:
1.
In Tree View, click the Subsystem
icon.
2.
In Management View, click the Settings tab.
3.
Enter a name into the Alias field.
Maximum of 48 characters. Use letters, numbers, space between words,
and underscore.
4.
Click the Submit button.
Setting Redundancy for the Subsystem
To set redundancy for this subsystem:
1.
In Tree View, click the Subsystem
2.
In Management View, click the Settings tab.
3.
In the Redundancy Type dropdown menu, select:
4.
icon.
•
Active-Active – Both RAID controllers are active and can share the load
•
Active-Standby – One RAID controller is in standby mode and goes
active if the other fails
Click the Submit button.
If you change Redundancy Type, be sure both controllers are properly installed in
the subsystem before you restart.
If your subsystem has dual controllers and they are set to Active-Active, you can
use the LUN Affinity feature. See “Making Controller Settings” on page 107.
Setting Cache Mirroring for the Subsystem
This option applies only to subsystems with two controllers. To use Cache
Mirroring, the Redundancy Type must be set to Active-Active.
To change Cache Mirroring for this subsystem:
1.
In Tree View, click the Subsystem
62
icon.
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
2.
3.
In Management View, click the Settings tab.
Do one of the following actions:
•
To enable Cache Mirroring, check the Cache Mirroring box.
•
To disable Cache Mirroring, uncheck the Cache Mirroring box.
4.
Click the Submit button.
5.
Restart the subsystem.
See “Restarting the Subsystem” on page 104.
Notes
•
If you disable Cache Mirroring, LUN Affinity will be enabled
automatically.
•
If you change Cache Mirroring, be sure both controllers are
properly installed in the subsystem before you restart.
Setting Subsystem Date and Time
To set a Date and Time for this subsystem:
1.
In Tree View, click the Subsystem
2.
In Management View, click the Settings tab dropdown menu and select Date
and Time Settings.
icon.
3.
Under Subsystem Date, select the Month and Day from the dropdown
menus.
4.
Type the current year into the Year field.
5.
Under Subsystem Time, select the Hour, Minutes and Seconds from the
dropdown menus.
6.
Click the Submit button.
Viewing the Runtime Event Log
Runtime Events lists information about the 1023 most recent runtime events
recorded since the system was started. To view runtime events:
1.
In Tree View, click the Subsystem
icon.
2.
In Management View, click the Events tab dropdown menu and select
Runtime Events.
Events are displayed by:
•
Item Number – A consecutive decimal number assigned to a specific
event
•
Device – Battery, controller, logical drive, physical drive, port, etc.
63
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
3.
•
Event ID – The hexadecimal number that identifies the specific type of
event
•
Severity – Information, Warning, Minor, Major, Critical, and Fatal. The
severity level is user-specified. See “Setting-up User Event
Subscriptions” on page 73.
•
Time – Time and date of the occurrence
•
Description – A brief description of the event
Click on the link at the top of the column by which you want to sort the
events. After you click on the item, a triangle icon appears.
•
If the triangle points upward, the column is sorted low-to-high or old-tonew.
•
If the triangle points downward, the column is sorted high-to-low or newto-old.
Click the link a second time to change to flip the triangle and reverse the sort
sequence.
Saving the Runtime Event Log
To save the runtime event log as a text file:
1.
In Tree View, click the Subsystem
icon.
2.
In Management View, click the Events tab dropdown menu and select
Runtime Events.
3.
Click the Save Event Log button.
4.
In the File Download dialog box, click the Save button.
5.
In the Save dialog box, name the file, navigate to the folder where you want
to save the log file, and click the Save button.
Clearing the Runtime Event Log
To clear the runtime event log:
1.
In Tree View, click the Subsystem
icon.
2.
In Management View, click the Events tab dropdown menu and select
Runtime Events.
3.
Click the Clear Event Log button.
4.
In the Confirmation dialog box, type confirm and click the OK button.
64
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Viewing NVRAM Events
NVRAM Events lists information about the 63 most recent important events.
NVRAM events are stored in non-volatile memory. To view runtime events:
1.
In Tree View, click the Subsystem
icon.
2.
In Management View, click the Events tab dropdown menu and select
System Events in NVRAM.
Events are displayed by:
3.
•
Item Number – A consecutive decimal number assigned to a specific
event
•
Device – Battery, controller, logical drive, physical drive, port, etc.
•
Event ID – The hexadecimal number that identifies the specific type of
event
•
Severity – Information, Warning, Minor, Major, Critical, and Fatal. The
severity level is user-specified. See “Setting-up User Event
Subscriptions” on page 73.
•
Time – Time and date of the occurrence
•
Description – A brief description of the event
Click on the link at the top of the column by which you want to sort the
events. After you click on the item, a triangle icon appears.
•
If the triangle points upward, the column is sorted low-to-high or old-tonew.
•
If the triangle points downward, the column is sorted high-to-low or newto-old.
Click the link a second time to change to flip the triangle and reverse the sort
sequence.
Saving NVRAM Events
To save the NVRAM event log as a text file:
1.
In Tree View, click the Subsystem
2.
In Management View, click the Events tab dropdown menu and select
System Events in NVRAM.
icon.
3.
Click the Save Event Log button.
4.
In the File Download dialog box, click the Save button.
5.
In the Save dialog box, name the file, navigate to the folder where you want
to save the log file, and click the Save button.
65
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Clearing NVRAM Events
To clear the NVRAM event log:
1.
In Tree View, click the Subsystem
icon.
2.
In Management View, click the Events tab dropdown menu and select
System Events in NVRAM.
3.
Click the Clear Event Log button.
4.
In the Confirmation dialog box, type confirm and click the OK button.
Viewing Current Background Activities
To view the current background activities:
1.
In Tree View, click the Subsystem
2.
In Management View, click the Background Activities tab.
icon.
A list of current background activities appears, including:
•
Rebuild
•
PDM – Predictive Data Migration
•
Synchronization
•
Redundancy Check
•
Migration
•
Transition
•
Initialization
•
Media Patrol
Making Background Activity Settings
To make settings for background activities:
1.
In Tree View, click the Subsystem
2.
In Management View, click the Background Activities tab and select Settings
from the dropdown menu.
3.
Click the dropdown menu to choose a priority of Low, Medium, and High for
the following functions:
•
icon.
Rebuild – Rebuilds the data from a failed drive in a disk array
•
Synchronization – Checks the data integrity on disk arrays
•
Initialization – Sets all data bits in the logical drive to zero
•
Redundancy Check – Checks, reports and can correct data
inconsistencies in logical drives
•
Migration – Change RAID level or add physical dries to disk arrays
66
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
•
PDM – Looks for bad blocks the physical drives of disk arrays
•
Transition – Returns a revertible spare drive to spare status
The rates are defined as follows:
4.
5.
6.
•
Low – Fewer resources to activity, more to data read/write.
•
Medium – Balance of resources to activity and data read/write.
•
High – More resources to activity, fewer to data read/write.
Highlight the following PDM trigger settings and type a value into the
corresponding field:
•
Reassigned Block Threshold – 1 to 512 blocks
•
Error Block Threshold – 1 to 1024 blocks
Check to enable or uncheck to disable the following functions:
•
Media Patrol – Checks the magnetic media on physical drives
•
Auto Rebuild – If there is a spare drive of adequate capacity, a critical
disk array will begin to rebuild automatically. If not spare drive is
available, the disk array will begin to rebuild as soon as you replace the
failed physical drive with an unconfigured physical drive of equal or
greater size.
Click the Submit button to save your settings.
Running Background Activities
To run a background activity from the Background Activities tab:
1.
In Tree View, click the Subsystem
icon.
2.
In Management View, click the Background Activities tab and select one of
the following from the dropdown menu.
•
Media Patrol – See “Running Media Patrol” on page 68
•
Rebuild – See “Rebuilding a Disk Array” on page 130
•
PDM – See “Running PDM” on page 68
•
Transition – See “Transitioning a Disk Array” on page 132
•
Initialization – See “Initializing a Logical Drive” on page 137
•
Redundancy Check – See “Running Redundancy Check” on page 137
3.
In the next screen, make the choices as requested.
4.
Click the Start button.
67
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Running Media Patrol
Media Patrol checks the magnetic media on physical drives. When it finds the
specified number of bad blocks, it will trigger PDM. See “Making Background
Activity Settings” on page 66 and “Running PDM” on page 68.
You can schedule Media Patrol to run automatically, see “Scheduling an Activity”
on page 69.
To run Media Patrol:
1.
In Tree View, click the Subsystem
2.
From the dropdown menu on the Background Activities tab, select Start
Media Patrol.
icon.
3.
In the next screen, click the Start button.
Running PDM
Predictive Data Migration (PDM) migrates data from the suspect physical drive to
a spare disk drive, similar to Rebuilding. But unlike Rebuilding, PDM acts before
the disk drive fails and your Logical Drive goes Critical.
You an also run PDM on a specific disk array, see “Running PDM on a Disk
Array” on page 131.
Also see “Predictive Data Migration (PDM)” on page 256.
To run PDM:
1.
In Tree View, click the Subsystem
2.
In Management View, click the Background Activities tab and select Start
Media Patrol from the dropdown menu.
icon.
3.
In the next screen, select the Source and Target physical drives.
The suspect physical drive is the source. The replacement physical drive is
the target.
4.
Click the Start button.
Viewing Scheduled Activities
To view scheduled activities for this subsystem:
1.
Click the Subsystem
2.
Click the Scheduler tab in Management View.
icon Tree View.
68
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Scheduling an Activity
To set a scheduled activity for this subsystem:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon Tree View.
2.
From the dropdown menu on the Scheduler tab, choose an item:
•
Media Patrol. See “Running Media Patrol” on page 68
•
Redundancy Check. See “Running Redundancy Check” on page 137
•
Battery Reconditioning. See “Reconditioning a Battery” on page 114
•
Spare Drive Check. See “Running Spare Check” on page 144
3.
In the Scheduler dialog box, check the Enable This Schedule box.
4.
Select a start time (24-hour clock).
5.
Select a Recurrence Pattern.
•
Daily – Enter the number of days between events.
•
Weekly – Enter the number of weeks between events and select which
days of the week.
•
Monthly – Select a calendar day of the month (1 – 31).
If you select a higher number than there are days in the current month, the
actual start date will occur at the beginning of the following month.
Or, select a day of the week and select the first, second, third, fourth, or last
occurrence of that day in the month.
Then, select the months in which you want the activity to occur.
6.
Select a Range of Occurrence.
•
Start-from date. The default is today's date.
•
End-on date.
Select No End Date (perpetual).
Or, select a number of occurrences for this activity.
Or, select a specific end date. The default is today's date.
7.
For Redundancy Check only:
•
Choose the Auto Fix option. This feature attempts to repair the problem
when it finds an error.
•Choose the Pause on Error option. This feature stops the process when it
finds an error
•
Check the boxes beside the logical drives (all except RAID 0) to which
this activity will apply.
Each logical drive can have only one scheduled Redundancy Check.
69
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Note
You can schedule only ONE Redundancy Check for each logical
drive.
8.
Click the Submit button.
Deleting a Scheduled Activity
To delete a scheduled activity for this subsystem:
1.
Click the Subsystem
2.
From the dropdown menu on the Scheduler tab, choose Delete Schedules.
icon Tree View.
3.
Check the box to the left of the schedule you want to delete.
4.
Click the Submit button.
Viewing Lock Status
The lock prevents other sessions (including by the same user) from making a
configuration change to the controller until the lock expires or a forced unlock is
done.
To view the lock status for this subsystem:
1.
Click the Subsystem
2.
Click the Lock tab in Management View.
icon Tree View.
The following information is displayed:
•
Lock Status – The User who set (owns) the current lock.
•
Expiration Time – Amount of time left until the lock automatically
releases.
•
Expire At Time – The date and time when the lock will automatically
release.
Setting the Lock
The lock prevents other sessions (including by the same user) from making a
configuration change to the controller until the lock expires or a forced unlock is
done.
You can set the lock to last from one minute to one day. To set the lock for this
subsystem:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon Tree View.
70
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
2.
Click the Lock tab in Management View.
3.
Click the Lock option.
4.
Enter a time interval between 1 and 1440 minutes (one day) that you want
the lock to stay active.
5.
Click the Submit button.
Renewing the Lock
The lock prevents other sessions (including by the same user) from making a
configuration change to the controller until the lock expires or a forced unlock is
done.
Renewing the lock extends the period of time the controller remains locked. To
renew an existing lock for this subsystem:
1.
Click the Subsystem
2.
Click the Lock tab in Management View.
icon Tree View.
3.
Click the Renew option.
4.
Enter a time interval between 1 and 1440 minutes (one day) that you want
the lock to stay active.
The renew time replaces the previous Expiration Time.
5.
Click the Submit button.
Releasing the Lock
The lock prevents other sessions (including by the same user) from making a
configuration change to the controller until the lock expires or a forced unlock is
done.
When the user who locked the controller logs out, the lock is automatically
released. You can also release the lock before the scheduled time.
To release the lock for this subsystem:
1.
Click the Subsystem
2.
Click the Lock tab in Management View.
icon Tree View.
If you are the User who set the lock, click the Unlock option.
If another User set the lock and you are a Super User, click the Unlock
option and check the Force Unlock box.
3.
Click the Submit button.
71
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Managing Users
User Management includes all functions dealing with user accounts. Functions
include:
•
Viewing User Information (page 72)
•
Making User Settings (page 72)
•
Making Your Own User Settings (page 73)
•
Setting-up User Event Subscriptions (page 73)
•
Changing Another User’s Password (page 74)
•
Changing Your Own Password (page 74)
•
Creating a User (page 75)
•
Deleting a User (page 76)
•
Viewing User Sessions (page 76)
•
Logging out Other Users (page 76)
Viewing User Information
The view a list of users, their status, access privileges, display name, and email
address:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the User Management
icon.
icon.
The Information tab appears in Management View.
Making User Settings
To change settings of other users:
1.
Log into WebPAM PROe as the Administrator or a Super User.
2.
Click the Subsystem
3.
Click the Administrative Tools
4.
Click the User Management
5.
On the Information tab, click the link of the user whose settings you want to
change.
icon in Tree View.
icon.
icon.
The Settings screen for the selected user displays.
6.
Make the following settings as needed.
•
Check the Enable box to enable this user.
•
Uncheck the box to disable this user.
•
Enter or change the display name.
72
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
•
Enter or change the email address.
•
From the Privilege dropdown menu, choose a new level.
See “List of User Privileges” on page 75
7.
Click the Submit button.
The Administrator or Super User can change another user’s password. See
“Changing Another User’s Password” on page 74 for more information.
Making Your Own User Settings
To change your own user settings:
1.
Log into WebPAM PROe under your own user name.
2.
Click the Subsystem
3.
Click the Administrative Tools
4.
Click the User Management
5.
Click the Settings tab in Management View.
6.
Enter or change the display name or mail address.
7.
Click the Submit button.
icon in Tree View.
icon.
icon.
Setting-up User Event Subscriptions
An event subscription enables a user to receive email messages about events
taking place in the VTrak subsystem. To make or change user event
subscriptions:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the User Management
icon.
icon.
4.
Click the Event Subscription tab in Management View.
5.
Check the box to enable event notification.
6.
Under the subheadings, select the lowest level of Severity to be reported for
each event. The selected level plus all higher levels of Severity will be
reported.
•
Information – Information only, no action is required
•
Warning – User can decide whether or not action is required
•
Minor – Action is needed but the condition is not a serious at this time
•
Major – Action is needed now
•
Critical – Action is needed now and the implications of the condition are
serious
73
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
7.
•
Fatal – Non-Recoverable error or failure has occurred
•
None – Deactivates this event for notification purposes
Click the Submit button.
The user’s account must have an email address. See “Making User Settings” on
page 72.
For information about the email service, see “Making Email Settings” on page 90.
To send a test message to the email address in the listed under General Info,
click the Test Email button.
Changing Another User’s Password
To change a user’s password:
1.
Log into WebPAM PROe as the Administrator or a Super User.
2.
Click the Subsystem
3.
Click the Administrative Tools
4.
Click the User Management
5.
In the list of users, click the link of the user whose settings you want to
change.
icon in Tree View.
icon.
icon.
The Settings screen for the selected user displays.
6.
Click the Password tab in Management View.
7.
Enter the new password in the New Password field.
8.
Enter the new password in the Retype Password field.
9.
Click the Submit button.
Changing Your Own Password
To set or change your own password:
1.
Log into WebPAM PROe under your own user name.
2.
Click the Subsystem
3.
Click the Administrative Tools
4.
Click the User Management
5.
Click the Password tab in Management View.
6.
Enter the current password in the Old Password field.
icon in Tree View.
icon.
icon.
If you do not have a password, leave this field blank.
7.
Enter the new password in the New Password field.
8.
Enter the new password in the Retype Password field.
74
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
9.
Click the Submit button.
Creating a User
To create a user:
1.
Log into WebPAM PROe as the Administrator or a Super User.
2.
Click the Subsystem
3.
Click the Administrative Tools
4.
Click the User Management
5.
Click the Create tab in Management View.
6.
Enter a user name in the User Name field.
7.
Enter a password for this user in the New Password and Retype Password
fields.
icon in Tree View.
icon.
icon.
A password is optional. If you do not specify a password, log into WebPAM
PROe with the User Name and leave the password field blank.
8.
Enter a display name in the Display Name field.
A display name is optional.
9.
Enter the user's email address in the Email Address field.
An email address is required in order to receive email event notification.
10. Select a privilege level from the Privilege dropdown menu.
For definitions of each privilege level, see the List of User Privileges below.
11. Check the Enabled box to enable this user on this subsystem.
12. Click the Submit button.
List of User Privileges
•
View – Allows the user to see all status and settings but not to make any
changes
•
Maintenance – Allows the user to perform maintenance tasks including
Rebuilding, PDM, Media Patrol, and Redundancy Check
•
Power – Allows the user to create (but not delete) disk arrays and logical
drives, change RAID levels, change stripe size; change settings of
components such as disk arrays, logical drives, physical drives, and the
controller.
•
Super – Allows the user full access to all functions including create and
delete users and changing the settings of other users, and delete disk arrays
and logical drives. The default “administrator” account is a Super User.
75
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Deleting a User
There will always be at least one Super User account. You cannot delete the user
account you used to log in.
To delete a user:
1.
Log into WebPAM PROe as the Administrator or a Super User.
2.
Click the Subsystem
3.
Click the Administrative Tools
4.
Click the User Management
5.
Click the Delete tab in Management View.
6.
Check the box to the left of the user you want to delete.
7.
Click the Submit button.
8.
Click OK in the confirmation box.
icon in Tree View.
icon.
icon.
Viewing User Sessions
To view the current sessions:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the User Management
4.
Click the Sessions tab in Management View.
icon.
icon.
Logging out Other Users
To logout other users:
1.
Log into WebPAM PROe as the Administrator or a Super User.
2.
Click the Subsystem
3.
Click the Administrative Tools
4.
Click the User Management
5.
Click the Sessions tab in Management View.
6.
Check the box to the left of the user you want to log out.
7.
Click the Logout button.
8.
Click OK in the confirmation box.
icon in Tree View.
icon.
icon.
76
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Managing the Network Connection
The network connection deals with network connections to the VTrak’s
Management Ports. Functions include:
•
Making Subsystem Management Port Settings (page 77)
•
Making Controller Management Port Settings (page 77)
Making Subsystem Management Port Settings
The VTrak subsystem has a virtual management port. When you log into the
VTrak over your network, you use the virtual management port. This
arrangement enables you to log into a VTrak with two controllers using one IP
address.
Before you change settings, please see “Choosing DHCP or a Static IP Address”
on page 36.
To make changes to the Subsystem Management Port settings:
1.
Click the Subsystem
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the Network Management
4.
Click the Port Configuration link in Management View.
5.
icon in Tree View.
icon.
icon.
To enable DHCP, check the DHCP box.
When DHCP is NOT enabled, enter:
6.
•
Primary IP address
•
Primary subnet mask
•
Default gateway IP address
•
Enter a primary DNS server IP address.
Click the Submit button.
Making Controller Management Port Settings
The controller has an IP addresses for access when the controller goes into
maintenance mode. Maintenance mode is only for remedial action in the event of
a problem with the controller. See “Controller Enters Maintenance Mode” on
page 298 for more information.
To make changes to the Controller Management Port settings:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the Network Management
icon.
icon.
77
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
4.
Click the Maintenance Mode tab in Management View.
5.
Click the Port Configuration link for Controller 1 or 2.
6.
To enable DHCP, check the DHCP box.
When DHCP is NOT enabled, enter:
•
Primary IP address
•
Primary subnet mask
•
Default gateway IP address
•
Enter a primary DNS server IP address.
7.
Click the Submit button.
8.
Click the Maintenance Mode tab again.
9.
Click the Port Configuration link for the other controller.
10. To enable DHCP, check the DHCP box.
When DHCP is NOT enabled, enter:
•
Primary IP address
•
Primary subnet mask
•
Default gateway IP address
•
Enter a primary DNS server IP address.
11. Click the Submit button.
78
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Managing Fibre Channel Connections
This feature pertains to VTrak Fibre Channel models. Functions include:
•
Viewing Fibre Channel Node Information (page 79)
•
Viewing Fibre Channel Port Settings (page 79)
•
Making Fibre Channel Port Settings (page 80)
•
Viewing Fibre Channel Port Statistics (page 81)
•
Viewing SFP Information (page 81)
•
Viewing Fibre Channel Logged-in Devices (page 82)
•
Viewing Fibre Channel Initiators (page 82)
Viewing Fibre Channel Node Information
To view Fibre Channel node information:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the Fibre Channel Management
4.
Click the Node tab in Management View.
icon.
icon.
The current node (data port) settings the Controller are shown, including:
•
WWNN – World Wide Node Name
•
Supported Features – Class of service
•
Maximum Frame Size – 2048 bits
•
Supported Speeds – 4 Gb/s, 2Gb/s, or 1 Gb/s
Viewing Fibre Channel Port Settings
To view the current Fibre Channel port settings:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the Fibre Channel Management
4.
Click the Port tab in Management View
icon.
icon.
The current data port settings the Controller are shown, including:
•
State – Online, Offline, Unknown
•
Port Identifier – A hexadecimal name for this port
•
Topology Attached – See the table on page 81
•
Fabric WWNN – World Wide Node Name (appears when connected to a
switch)
79
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
•
Fabric WWPN – World Wide Port Name (appears when connected to a
switch)
•
Current Speed – 4 Gb/s, 2 Gb/s, or 1 Gb/s
•
Link Type – Long-wave laser, short-wave laser or electrical
•
Symbolic Name – A text name for this port
•
Link Speed* – 4 Gb/s, 2 Gb/s, 1 Gb/s, or Auto
•
Topology* – NL-Port, N-Port, or Auto
•
Hard ALPA* – Address can be 0 to 254. 255 means this feature is
disabled
•
Alias WWPN
* Denotes items that you can change under Port Settings, below.
Making Fibre Channel Port Settings
To make Fibre Channel port settings:
1.
Click the Subsystem
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the Fibre Channel Management
4.
Click the Port tab in Management View
5.
Click the Port1 or Port2 link in Management View.
6.
Make the settings appropriate to your system. See “Port Setting Information”
on page 81.
7.
icon in Tree View.
icon.
icon.
•
Configured Link Speed – 4 Gb/s, 2 Gb/s, 1 Gb/s or Auto (self-setting)
•
Configured Topology – N-Port (Point-to-Point), NL Port (Arbitrated Loop)
or Auto (self-setting)
•
Hard ALPA – Address can be 0 to 254. 255 means this feature is
disabled. An ALPA identifies a port in an arbitrated loop.
Click the Submit button to save your settings.
80
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Port Setting Information
The table below shows the type of attached topology you will achieve based
on your connection type and the configured topology you select.
Fibre Channel Attached Topology
Configured Topology
Connection Type
N-Port
NL-Port
Switch
Fabric Direct
Public Loop
Direct
Point to Point
Private Loop
Example 1: If you connect the VTrak to a Fibre Channel switch and select
NL-Port topology, you will create a Public Loop attached topology.
Example 2: If you have a Point to Point attached topology, you made a direct
connection (no switch) and selected N-port topology.
Note
In some cases, HBA settings to N-Port only work if connected to
the switch. Refer to your HBA manual for more information.
Viewing Fibre Channel Port Statistics
To view statistics for the Fibre Channel ports:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the Fibre Channel Management
4.
Click the Statistic tab in Management View.
icon.
icon.
The statistics for all Fibre Channel ports are shown.
Clearing Statistics
To clear statistics, see “Clearing Statistics” on page 102.
Viewing SFP Information
SFPs (small form-factor pluggable) transceivers connect the ports the VTrak
controllers to the Fibre Channel fabric.
To view SFP information:
81
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the Fibre Channel Management
4.
Click the SFP tab in Management View.
icon.
icon.
The SFP information for all Fibre Channel ports is shown.
SFP Information
•
Connector – Type of connector
•
Transceiver – SFP
•
Transceiver Code – Defines the method to interpret the transceiver type and
compatibility options
•
Serial Encoding – Serial encoding algorithm
•
Bit Rate – In gigabits per second
•
Link Length – The maximum link length depending the type of fiber
•
Vendor Name – Vendor name of the SFP transceiver
•
Vendor OUI – Organizational Unique Identifier, SFP vendor’s IEEE company
ID
•
Vendor Part Number
•
Vendor Revision
•
Vendor Serial Number
•
Manufacturing Date – Code with 2 digits each for year, month, day, and
optional vendor-specific lot number
Viewing Fibre Channel Logged-in Devices
To view a list of the devices currently logged into the VTrak:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the Fibre Channel Management
4.
Click the Logged In Device tab in Management View.
icon.
icon.
One of the devices in the list will be the port itself. If there is no other device,
this notification will appear: “There is no logged in device.” If a Fibre Channel
switch is attached, it will also appear in this list.
Viewing Fibre Channel Initiators
You must add an initiator to the VTrak's initiator list in order to use the initiator to
create a LUN for your logical drive.
82
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
To view a list of recognized initiators:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the Fibre Channel Management
4.
Click the Initiator tab in Management View.
icon.
icon.
A Fibre Channel switch will also display as an initiator in the list. If your Host
PC's Fibre Channel HBA is connected to the VTrak directly (not though a
Fibre Channel switch), the initiator will NOT display in the initiator list.
Adding an Initiator
To add an initiator to the VTrak’s initiator list:
1.
Check the box to the left of the initiator.
2.
Click the Add to Initiator List button.
The initiator appears under Storage Services. See page 87. You can then use the
initiator to create a LUN. See “Adding a LUN Map” on page 88.
83
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Managing SAS Connections
This feature pertains to VTrak Serial Attached SCSI models. Functions include:
•
Viewing SAS Port Information (page 84)
•
Making SAS Port Settings (page 84)
•
Viewing SAS Port Statistics (page 85)
•
Viewing SAS Initiators (page 85)
Viewing SAS Port Information
A SAS Controller can have one or two SAS channels. Each SAS channel has two
ports:
•
Host In or Data Port (a table-routed port)
•
Host In/Out or Data Cascade Port (a subtractive-routed port)
See “Serial Attached SCSI” on page 26 for information about how these ports are
physically connected to the Host PC or other subsystems.
To view information about the SAS ports:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the SAS Management
icon.
icon.
The port information appears the screen.
•
Channel ID
•
Port Type
•
Link Status
•
Link Speed
•
SAS Address
•
Cable Signal Strength – Adjustable under Port Settings
See “Serial Attached SCSI” on page 26 for information about how these ports are
physically connected to the Host PC or other subsystems.
Making SAS Port Settings
A SAS Controller can have one or two SAS channels. Each SAS channel has two
ports:
•
Host In or Data Port (a table-routed port)
•
Host In/Out or Data Cascade Port (a subtractive-routed port)
To make settings to the SAS ports:
84
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the SAS Management
4.
In Management View, click the Port 1 or Port 2 link.
5.
From the Cable Signal Strength dropdown menu, choose a value.
icon.
icon.
The range is 1 to 8. 1 is the default. Signal strength correlates to cable length
in meters. Example: If you have a 2 m SAS cable, set signal strength to 2. If
performance is unsatisfactory (see “Viewing SAS Port Statistics” on
page 85), try settings of 1 and 3, then use the best setting for your system.
6.
Click the Submit button.
Viewing SAS Port Statistics
The SAS Management Statistics tab displays statistical information about all of
the SAS ports on the VTrak subsystem.
To view information about the SAS ports:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the SAS Management
4.
In Management View, click the Statistic tab.
icon.
icon.
The statistics for the selected port appear the screen.
Clearing Statistics
To clear statistics, see “Clearing Statistics” on page 102.
Viewing SAS Initiators
You must add an initiator to the VTrak's initiator list in order to use the initiator to
create a LUN for your logical drive.
To view a list of recognized initiators:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the SAS Management
4.
In Management View, click the Initiators tab.
icon.
icon.
A list of all currently logged-in initiators appears the screen.
85
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Adding an Initiator
To add an initiator to the VTrak’s initiator list:
1.
Check the box to the left of the initiator.
2.
Click the Add to Initiator List button.
The initiator appears under Storage Services. See page 87. You can then use the
initiator to create a LUN. See “Adding a LUN Map” on page 88.
86
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Managing Storage Services
Storage services deal with initiators and LUN mapping for Fibre Channel models
and for Serial Attached SCSI models. LUN masking is the process of applying a
LUN Map so that each initiator can only access the LUNs specified for it.
Features include:
•
Adding an Initiator (page 87)
•
Deleting an Initiator (page 88)
•
Viewing the LUN Map (page 88)
•
Enabling LUN Masking (page 88)
•
Adding a LUN Map (page 88)
•
Editing a LUN Map (page 89)
Adding an Initiator
You must add an initiator to the VTrak's initiator list in order to use the initiator to
create a LUN
To add an initiator:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the Storage Services
4.
Click the Initiators tab in Management View.
5.
From the Initiators tab dropdown menu, select Add Initiator.
6.
Enter the initiator's name in the Initiator Name field.
icon.
icon.
•
Fibre Channel – A Fibre Channel initiator name is the World Wide Port
Name of the device and is composed of a series of eight, two-digit
hexadecimal numbers.
•
SAS – A SAS initiator name is the SAS address of the HBA card in the
Host PC. Obtain the initiator name from the initiator utility on your host
system.
Obtain the initiator name from the initiator utility on your host system.
Note that the initiator name you input must match exactly in order for the
connection to work.
7.
Click the Submit button.
You can also add initiators from the Fibre Channel or SAS Initiators tab. See
“Viewing Fibre Channel Initiators” on page 82 and “Viewing SAS Initiators” on
page 85.
87
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Deleting an Initiator
To delete an initiator:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the Storage Services
4.
Click the Initiators tab in Management View.
5.
From the Initiators tab dropdown menu, select Delete Initiators.
6.
Check the box to the left of the initiator you want to delete.
7.
Click the Submit button.
icon.
icon.
Viewing the LUN Map
To view the current LUN Map:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the Storage Services
4.
Click the LUN Map tab in Management View.
icon.
icon.
Enabling LUN Masking
To enable the LUN Masking:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the Storage Services
4.
Click the LUN Map tab in Management View.
5.
Click the LUN Masking Enabled box.
6.
Click the Submit button.
icon.
icon.
Adding a LUN Map
To edit the LUN Map:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the Storage Services
4.
Click the LUN Map tab in Management View and from the dropdown menu,
select Add a LUN Map.
icon.
icon.
88
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
5.
Select an initiator from the Initiator dropdown list.
Or enter the initiator’s name in the Initiator Name field.
Note that the initiator name you input must match exactly in order for the
connection to work.
6.
In the LUN Mapping & Masking list, enter the LUNs for each logical drive.
You must enter different LUN numbers for each logical drive.
7.
Click the Submit button.
Editing a LUN Map
To edit the LUN Map:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the Storage Services
icon.
icon.
4.
Click the LUN Map tab in Management View.
5.
From the LUN Mapping & Masking Information list, select an initiator and
click on its link.
6.
Select an initiator from the Initiator dropdown list.
Or enter the initiator's name in the Initiator Name field.
Note that the initiator name you input must match exactly in order for the
connection to work.
7.
In the LUN field, enter the LUNs for each logical drive.
You must enter different LUN numbers for each logical drive.
8.
Click the Submit button.
89
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Managing Software Services
Software Services include the following functions:
•
Making Email Settings (page 90)
•
Making SLP Settings (page 91)
•
Making Web Server Settings (page 91)
•
Making Telnet Settings (page 93)
•
Making SNMP Settings (page 93)
•
Making CIM Settings (page 95)
•
Making Netsend Settings (page 96)
Making Email Settings
The Email sends notification messages to users. See Setting-up User Event
Subscriptions (page 73).
To make Email service settings:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
icon.
3.
Click the Email Setting link in Management View.
4.
Enter the IP address for your SMTP server.
5.
Enter server port number for your SMTP server.
25 is the default.
6.
Select Yes to enable SMTP authentication or No to Yes.
7.
If you selected Yes for SMTP authentication, enter a Username and
Password in the fields provided.
8.
Enter an Email sender address (example: RAIDmaster@mycompany.com).
9.
Enter an Email subject (example: VTrak Status).
10. Click the Submit button.
Sending a Test Message
To send one test message to the User currently logged into WebPAM PROe:
1.
Under Test Email, check the “Send A Test Email” box.
2.
Click the Submit button.
If you do not receive the Test Email message, see your Network Administrator for
assistance with the mail server setup, email accounts, and other issues.
Changing the Startup Setting
1.
Under Startup Type:
90
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
2.
•
Click on the Automatic option to start the service automatically during
system startup. Recommended.
•
Click on the Manual option to start the service manually (the service
does not start during system startup).
Click on the Submit button.
Stopping Email service
To stop the Email service:
1.
Click the Stop button.
2.
Click OK in the confirmation box.
Starting or Restarting Email service
To start or restart the Email service, click the Start or Restart button.
Making SLP Settings
VTrak's SLP service discovers services available over the Internet. To make SLP
service settings:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click on the Software Management
4.
Click the SLP link.
5.
Choose the Startup Type.
6.
icon.
icon.
•
Click on the Automatic option to start the service automatically during
system startup. Recommended.
•
Click on the Manual option to start the service manually (the service
does not start during system startup).
Click the Submit button.
Stopping SLP service
To stop the SLP service:
1.
Click the Stop button.
2.
Click OK in the confirmation box.
Starting or Restarting SLP service
To start or restart the SLP service, click the Start or Restart button.
Making Web Server Settings
VTrak’s Web Server service connects the VTrak GUI to the VTrak subsystem
though your browser.
91
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
To make Web Server settings:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the Web Server Setting link in Management View.
4.
Enter the HTTP Port number.
icon.
80 is the default.
5.
Enter Session Time Out interval.
This setting causes WebPAM PROe to time-out after a period of inactivity. 24
minutes is the default. The range is 1 to 1440 minutes (one day).
6.
If you want to use a secure connection, check the Enable SSL box.
7.
If you checked the Enable SSL box, enter a HTTPS Port number.
443 is the default.
8.
If you want to download a SSL Certificate, check the Download Certificate
box.
9.
If you checked the Download Certificate box, enter the Certificate filename
or click the Browse... button to locate it.
10. Click the Submit button.
11. Click OK in the confirmation box to restart the Web Server service with your
changes.
Changing the Startup Setting
1.
2.
Under Startup Type:
•
Click on the Automatic option to start the service automatically during
system startup. Recommended.
•
Click on the Manual option to start the service manually (the service
does not start during system startup).
Click on the Submit button.
Stopping Web Server service
To stop the Web Server service:
1.
Click the Stop button.
2.
Click OK in the confirmation box.
Starting or Restarting Web Server service
To start or restart the Web Server service, click the Start or Restart button.
92
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Making Telnet Settings
VTrak’s Telnet service enables you to access VTrak’s Command Line Interface
(CLI) through a network connection. To make Telnet settings:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the Telnet Setting link in Management View.
4.
Enter the Telnet Port number.
icon.
2300 is the default.
5.
Enter the Maximum Number of Connections.
4 is the default.
6.
Enter the Session Time Out interval.
24 minutes is the default.
7.
Click the Submit button.
8.
Click OK in the confirmation box to restart the Telnet service with your
changes.
Changing the Startup Setting
1.
2.
Under Startup Type:
•
Click on the Automatic option to start the service automatically during
system startup. Recommended.
•
Click on the Manual option to start the service manually (the service
does not start during system startup).
Click on the Submit button.
Stopping Telnet service
To stop the Telnet service:
1.
Click the Stop button.
2.
Click OK in the confirmation box.
Starting or Restarting Telnet service
To start or restart the Telnet service, click the Start or Restart button.
Making SNMP Settings
VTrak’s SNMP service enables the SNMP browser to obtain information from the
VTrak. The Trap Sink is where SNMP events are sent and can be viewed.
To change the SNMP settings:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
93
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
icon.
3.
Click the SNMP Management link in Management View.
4.
Enter the SNMP Port number.
161 is the default.
5.
Enter a System Name.
There is no default name.
6.
Enter a System Location.
USA is the default.
7.
Enter a System Contact (the email address of the administrator or other
individual).
8.
Enter the Read Community.
Public is the default.
9.
Enter the Write Community.
Private is the default.
To add a Trap Sink, see “Adding Trap Sinks” below.
10. Click OK in the confirmation box to restart the SNMP service with your
changes.
Adding Trap Sinks
To add a trap sink:
1.
Enter a Trap Sink IP address.
2.
Select a Trap Filter, select the lowest level of Severity to be reported for each
event.
See “Setting-up User Event Subscriptions” on page 73 for an explanation of
the Severity levels.
3.
Click the Update button.
The new trap sink appears in the Trap Sinks list.
4.
Click the Submit button.
5.
Click OK in the confirmation box.
Deleting Trap Sinks
To delete a trap sink:
1.
Highlight the trap sink you want to delete from the list.
2.
Click the Delete button to remove the trap sink from the list.
3.
Click the Submit button.
4.
Click OK in the confirmation box.
94
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Changing the Startup Setting
1.
2.
Under Startup Type:
•
Click on the Automatic option to start the service automatically during
system startup. Recommended.
•
Click on the Manual option to start the service manually (the service
does not start during system startup).
Click on the Submit button.
Stopping SNMP service
To stop the SNMP service:
1.
Click the Stop button.
2.
Click OK in the confirmation box.
Starting or Restarting SNMP service
To start or restart the SNMP service, click the Start or Restart button.
Making CIM Settings
VTrak’s CIM (Common Information Model [a protocol]) service provides a
database for information about computer systems and network devices.
To change the CIM settings:
1.
Click the Subsystem
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the CIM Setting link in Management View.
4.
Click the Start button to start the CIM service.
5.
To enable CIM using a HTTP connection:
6.
7.
icon in Tree View.
icon.
•
Choose the Yes option
•
Enter a port number in the field provided (5988 is the default)
To enable CIM using a HTTPS connection:
•
Choose the Yes option
•
Enter a port number in the field provided (5989 is the default)
To enable authentication for your CIM connection(s):
•
Choose the Yes option
•
Enter the old password in the field provided (password is the default)
•
Enter a new password in the field provided
To change your password, the CIM service must be running. See “Starting or
Restarting CIM service” on page 96.
There is only one user. The default name is “cim.” No changes are possible.
95
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
8.
Click the Submit button.
Changing the Startup Setting
1.
2.
Under Startup Type:
•
Click on the Automatic option to start the service automatically during
system startup. Recommended.
•
Click on the Manual option to start the service manually (the service
does not start during system startup).
Click on the Submit button.
Stopping CIM service
To stop the CIM service:
1.
Click the Stop button.
2.
Click OK in the confirmation box.
Starting or Restarting CIM service
To start or restart the CIM service, click the Start or Restart button.
Making Netsend Settings
VTrak’s Netsend service sends VTrak subsystem events in the form of text
messages to your Host PC and other networked PCs. This service is normally
Stopped and set to Manual start. See “Netsend Requirements” on page 97.
To change the Netsend settings:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the Netsend link.
4.
Click the Start button to start the Netsend service.
5.
Click the Submit button.
icon.
Adding Netsend recipients
See “Netsend Requirements” on page 97. To add a Netsent recipient:
1.
In the Recipient Address field, type the IP address of the recipient PC.
2.
Under Recipient filter, select the lowest level of Severity to be reported for
each event.
See “Setting-up User Event Subscriptions” on page 73 for an explanation of
the Severity levels.
3.
Click the Update button to add the new recipient to the list
4.
Click the Submit button.
5.
Click OK in the confirmation box.
96
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Deleting Netsend Recipients
To delete a Netsend recipient:
1.
Highlight the recipient you want to delete in the recipient list.
2.
Click the Delete button to remove the recipient from the list.
3.
Click the Submit button.
4.
Click OK in the confirmation box.
Changing the Startup Setting
1.
2.
Under Startup Type:
•
Click on the Automatic option to start the service automatically during
system startup. Recommended if you plan to use this feature.
•
Click on the Manual option to start the service manually (the service
does not start during system startup). The default setting.
Click on the Submit button.
Stopping Netsend service
To stop the Netsend service:
1.
Click the Stop button.
2.
Click OK in the confirmation box.
Starting or Restarting Netsend service
To start or restart the Netsend service, click the Start or Restart button.
Netsend Requirements
In order to use Netsend:
•
Netsend must be running the VTrak
•
You must provide the IP address for each recipient PC
•
The Messenger service must be running on each recipient PC
If your Netsend and Messenger service settings are correct but the recipient PC
does not receive event messages, check the recipient PC’s Firewall settings.
Refer to your OS documentation for more information.
97
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Exporting the User Database
You can export the User Database file to share user information and settings
among multiple VTrak subsystems.
The Export action saves a text file a designated folder the Host PC. From there,
you can import the User Database file to other VTrak subsystems.
To export the User Database file:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the Export link in Management View.
4.
Click the Export button.
5.
In the Opening export dialog box, click the Save to Disk option.
6.
Click the OK button.
icon.
The user database file is saved to the Host PC from which you access
WebPAM PROe.
Note
The Encryption box is grayed out. Encryption is always enabled.
98
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Importing a User Database
Caution
Do NOT use this function to update the VTrak firmware.
The Software Management–Import tab enables you to import the User Database
file from the Host PC's file system to the VTrak subsystem. When you make user
settings to one VTrak, you can export the User Database file to the Host PC.
From there, you can import the User Database file to other VTrak s so that all
have the same User information and settings.
To import the User Database file to this subsystem:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the Software Management
4.
Click the Import tab.
5.
Under the Type dropdown list, select User Database.
6.
Enter the name of the file to be imported.
icon.
icon.
Or, click the Browse... button to search for the file.
Look for a file called export.
7.
8.
Click the Submit button.
Click the Next button.
If the imported file is a valid user database, an warning will appear to inform
you that it will overwrite the previous settings.
9.
In the Warning box, click the OK button.
This user settings are applied to this VTrak subsystem.
Note
The Decryption box is grayed out. Decryption is always enabled.
99
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Updating the Firmware
This procedure is covered in Chapter 6: Maintenance. See “Updating the
Firmware in WebPAM PROe” on page 213 for instructions.
100
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Restoring Factory Defaults
VTrak includes a function to restore the default settings to its Firmware and
Software settings.
Caution
The action of restoring default settings can disrupt your VTrak
functions. Use this feature only when necessary and only the
settings that must reset to default in order to set them correctly.
To access the Restore Defaults feature:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
icon.
The Administrative Tools list appears.
3.
Click the Restore Factory Defaults link at the bottom of the list in
Management View.
The Restore Factory Defaults screen appears.
4.
Check the Firmware and Software functions you want to restore to default
settings.
5.
Click the Submit button.
6.
In the confirmation box, type the word confirm in the field provided.
7.
Click the OK button.
The functions you selected will be automatically restored to their default settings.
101
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Clearing Statistics
The Clear Statistics function clears statistical data on controllers, Fibre Channel
ports, SAS ports, physical drives, and logical drives. To clear statistical data:
1.
Click the Subsystem
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
icon in Tree View.
icon.
Click the Clear Statistics link.
The Clear Statistics tab appears in Management View.
4.
Click the Submit button.
5.
In the confirmation box, type the word confirm in the field provided.
6.
Click the OK button.
102
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Shutting Down the Subsystem
You can only do part of this function in WebPAM PROe. Additional action is
required, as described below. To shutdown the subsystem:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the Shutdown link in Management View.
icon.
A Shutdown or Restart tab will appear.
4.
On the Shutdown or Restart tab, select Shutdown from the dropdown menu.
5.
Click the Submit button.
6.
In the confirmation box, type the word confirm in the field provided.
7.
Click the OK button.
When the controller shuts down, your WebPAM PROe connection will be
lost.
8.
Wait for no less than two minutes.
9.
Manually turn off the power supply switches the back of the subsystem.
Monitoring the Shutdown
To monitor a shutdown, you must use the Command Line Interface (CLI) though
a serial connection to the VTrak.
At the “administrator@CLI>” prompt, type shutdown -a shutdown.
When the “Shutdown complete. It is now safe to power off the subsystem.”
message appears, turn off the power supply switches.
103
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Restarting the Subsystem
You can only do part of this function in WebPAM PROe. Additional action is
required, as described below. To restart the subsystem
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click the Shutdown link in Management View.
icon.
A Shutdown or Restart tab will appear.
4.
On the Shutdown or Restart tab, select Restart from the dropdown menu.
5.
Click the Submit button.
6.
In the warning box, click the OK button.
7.
In the confirmation box, type the word confirm in the field provided.
8.
Click the OK button.
When the controller shuts down, your WebPAM PROe connection will be
lost.
9.
Wait for two to three minutes.
10. In your browser, log into WebPAM PROe once again.
If you cannot log in, wait for 30 seconds, and try again. Repeat until login is
successful.
Monitoring the Restart
To monitor a restart, you must use the Command Line Interface (CLI) though a
serial connection to the VTrak.
At the “administrator@CLI>” prompt, type shutdown -a restart.
When the “Login:” prompt appears, the restart is finished.
104
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Managing Controllers
The RAID controllers are the heart of the VTrak subsystem. VTrak E-Class
models have one or two controllers. Management of Controllers includes the
following functions:
•
Viewing the Controllers (page 105)
•
Locating a Controller (page 105)
•
Viewing Controller Information (page 106)
•
Viewing Controller Statistics (page 107)
•
Making Controller Settings (page 107)
•
Clearing an Orphan Watermark (page 108)
Viewing the Controllers
To view information about the controllers:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Controllers
icon.
The controller information appears under the Information tab in Management
View. Controller information includes:
•
Controller ID (1 or 2)
•
Alias, if assigned
•
Model, if applicable
•
Status – OK means normal
•
Readiness Status – Active or Standby
•
Locate – Click on the button to locate the controller. See below
VTrak subsystems with only one controller will always show that the second
controller is “Missing.”
If your VTrak subsystem has two controllers and one is “Missing,” see “Controller
Enters Maintenance Mode” on page 298 for more information.
Locating a Controller
To identify a specific controller in the VTrak subsystem:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Controllers
icon.
3.
In Management View, click the Locate Controller button.
4.
The Controller Dirty Cache
LED and Status
LED, on the back of the
Controller, will flash for one minute. See the illustrations below.
105
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Figure 9. The VTrak E610f and E310f controller LEDs
Mgmt
FC 1
FC 2
4
2
UPS
4
2
1
1
Gb/s
Gb/s
115200
8N1
Status LED
Dirty Cache LED
Figure 10.The VTrak E610s and E310s controller LEDs
Mgmt
UPS
115200
8N1
Status LED
Dirty Cache LED
Viewing Controller Information
To view Controller information:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Controllers
icon.
3.
Click the Controller
icon.
The controller information appears the Information tab in Management View.
Adjustable items
You can set or adjust the following items:
•
Alias, if assigned
•
Coercion, enable or disable
•
Coercion Method
•
SMART – Self-Monitoring, Analysis, and Reporting System for physical
drives.
•
SMART Polling Interval
•
Write Back Cache Flush Interval
•
Enclosure Polling Interval
•
LUN Affinity
See “Making Controller Settings” on page 107.
106
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Upgradable items
You can upgrade the following items:
•
Boot loader Version
•
Firmware Version number
•
Software Version number
•
Memory Size
See “Chapter 6: Maintenance” on page 213.
Viewing Controller Statistics
To view controller statistics:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Controllers
icon.
3.
Click the Controller
4.
Click the Information tab in Management View and select Statistics from
dropdown menu.
icon.
Clearing Statistics
To clear statistics, see “Clearing Statistics” on page 102.
Making Controller Settings
If your subsystem has two controllers, any settings you make to one controller
will automatically apply to the other controller.
To make Controller settings:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Controllers
icon.
3.
Click the Controller
4.
Click the Settings tab in Management View.
5.
Make the following settings as needed:
•
icon.
Enter a name into the Alias field.
Maximum of 48 characters. Use letters, numbers, space between
words, and underscore. An alias is optional.
•
Check the Enable LUN affinity box to enable the LUN affinity feature.
If your subsystem has two controllers and Cache Mirroring is disabled,
LUN Affinity is enabled automatically.
•
Check the SMART Log box to enable the Self-Monitoring, Analysis, and
Reporting System (SMART).
107
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
•
Enter a polling interval (1 to 1440 minutes) in SMART Polling Interval
field.
•
Check the Coercion Enabled box to enable disk drive capacity coercion.
When disk drives of different capacities are used in the same array,
coercion reduces the usable capacity of the larger disk drive(s) in order
to match the smallest capacity drive.
For more information, see “Capacity Coercion” on page 250.
•
Select a coercion method from the Coercion Method dropdown menu.
The choices are:
GB Truncate – (Default) Reduces the useful capacity to the nearest
1,000,000,000 byte boundary.
10GB Truncate – Reduces the useful capacity to the nearest
10,000,000,000 byte boundary.
Group Rounding – Uses an algorithm to determine how much to
truncate. Results in the maximum amount of usable drive capacity.
Table Rounding – Applies a predefined table to determine how much
to truncate.
•
Enter a time interval (1 to 12 seconds) in the Write Back Cache Flush
Interval field.
For more information, see “Cache Policy” on page 246.
•
Enter a time interval (15 to 255 seconds) in the Enclosure Polling
Interval field.
•
Check the Adaptive Writeback Cache box to enable the Adaptive
Writeback Cache feature.
For more information, see “Adaptive Writeback Cache” on page 247.
6.
Click the Submit button.
The changes take effect immediately.
Clearing an Orphan Watermark
An Orphan Watermark condition is the result of a disk drive failure during an
NVRAM RAID level migration on a disk array.
To clear an Orphan Watermark:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Controllers
icon.
3.
Click the Controller
4.
Click on the Clear tab in Management View.
5.
Click the Submit button.
icon.
108
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
The changes take effect immediately. If your subsystem has two controllers,
clearing a condition on one controller will automatically apply to the other
controller.
109
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Managing Enclosures
On VTrak E-Class, enclosures include the main VTrak subsystem or Head Unit
as well as additional enclosures that are connected to it through cascading or
expansion. Enclosure Management includes the following functions:
•
Viewing the Enclosures (page 110)
•
Locating an Enclosure (page 110)
•
Viewing Enclosure Topology (page 111)
•
Viewing Enclosure Information (page 112)
•
Making Enclosure Settings (page 112)
•
Viewing FRU VPD Information (page 113)
•
Checking the Batteries (page 113)
•
Reconditioning a Battery (page 114)
•
Silencing the Buzzer (page 114)
•
Making Buzzer Settings (page 115)
•
Testing the Buzzer (page 115)
Viewing the Enclosures
To view information about the enclosures:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Enclosures
icon.
The following information is shown:
•
Enclosure ID number
•
Enclosure Type
•
Operational Status
•
Status Description – Specific components in need of attention, if any
Locating an Enclosure
To locate an enclosure (subsystem):
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Enclosures
icon.
3.
Click the Locate Enclosure button.
The Disk Status LEDs on the front of the enclosure will flash for one minute.
See the illustrations below.
110
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Figure 11. VTrak E610f and E610s front view
Drive Carrier LEDs
Drive Carriers
Power and Status LEDs
Figure 12.VTrak E310f and E310s front view
Drive Carrier LEDs
Drive Carriers
Power and Status LEDs
Figure 13.VTrak drive carrier LEDs
Disk Status
Viewing Enclosure Topology
To view Enclosure Topology:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Enclosures
icon.
111
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
3.
click the Topology tab in Management View.
Enclosure topology refers to the manner in which the data paths among the
enclosures are connected:
•
Individual Subsystem
•
JBOD Expansion – One VTrak E-Class subsystem plus one or more JBOD
expansion subsystems, managed through one subsystem or head unit
•
RAID Subsystem Cascading – Multiple VTrak E-Class subsystems,
managed through one subsystem or head unit
The logical connections for these arrangements are shown the Enclosure
Topology tab. The physical connections for these arrangements are discussed in
“Chapter 2: VTrak Installation” on page 11.
Viewing Enclosure Information
To view enclosure information:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Enclosures
icon.
3.
Click the Enclosure
icon.
Enclosure information appears the Information tab in Management View.
You can monitor power supplies, cooling units, enclosure temperatures and
voltages, and the battery.
Adjustable items
You can set or adjust the following items:
•
Enclosure Warning and Critical temperature thresholds
•
Controller Warning and Critical temperature thresholds
See “Making Enclosure Settings” on page 112.
For information on Enclosure problems, see “Chapter 8: Troubleshooting” on
page 261.
Making Enclosure Settings
To make Enclosure settings:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Enclosures
icon.
3.
Click the Enclosure
4.
Click the Settings tab in Management View.
5.
Enter a value in the following fields as necessary:
icon.
112
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
6.
•
Enclosure Warning Temperature Threshold
•
Enclosure Critical Temperature Threshold
•
Controller Warning Temperature Threshold
•
Controller Critical Temperature Threshold
Click the Submit button.
The changes take effect immediately.
Viewing FRU VPD Information
FRU VPD refers to Vital Product Data (VPD) information about Field Replaceable
Units (FRU) in the enclosure. The number and type of FRU depends on the
subsystem model.
To view FRU VPD information:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Enclosures
icon.
3.
Click the Enclosure
4.
Click the FRU VPD tab in Management View.
icon.
Use this information when communicating with Technical Support and when
ordering replacement units. For contact information, see “Contacting Technical
Support” on page 305.
Checking the Batteries
The Enclosure–Battery tab displays information about the cache backup battery
(or batteries) in the VTrak subsystem enclosure. To check the batteries:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Enclosures
icon.
3.
Click the Enclosure
4.
Click the Battery tab in Management View.
icon.
Battery Notes
Each battery works with a controller. If the battery is present in the subsystem but
the corresponding controller is not present, the battery will not appear in the
interface.
If a battery does not reflect normal conditions and it is not currently under
reconditioning, run the Recondition function before you replace the battery. See
“Reconditioning a Battery” on page 114.
Reconditioning fully discharges, then fully recharges the battery. During
reconditioning, if the Adaptive Writeback Cache function is enabled, the controller
113
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
cache is set to Write Thru. After reconditioning, the cache is reset to Write Back.
See “Making Controller Settings” on page 107.
If a battery reaches the threshold temperature while charging or discharging, the
charge or discharge pauses and the blower runs at high speed until the battery
temperature falls below the threshold.
If the battery does not maintain normal values after a Recondition, replace the
battery. See “Replacing a Cache Battery” on page 224.
VTrak automatically reconditions the battery every two months. To set the
schedule, see “Scheduling an Activity” on page 69.
When you install a new battery, the cycle count shows 0. VTrak automatically
runs a recondition on the battery to verify it. If you restart the subsystem or
controller before reconditioning is finished, the battery is charged to 100%, then
reconditioning starts again.
Reconditioning a Battery
To recondition the battery:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Enclosures
icon.
3.
Click the Enclosure
4.
Click the Battery tab in Management View.
5.
From the Battery tab dropdown menu, select Recondition.
6.
Click the Submit button.
icon.
Reconditioning fully discharges, then fully recharges the battery. During
reconditioning, if the Adaptive Writeback Cache function is enabled, the
controller cache is set to Write Thru. After reconditioning, the cache is reset
to Write Back. See “Making Controller Settings” on page 107.
VTrak automatically reconditions the battery every two months. To set the
recondition schedule, see “Scheduling an Activity” on page 69.
Silencing the Buzzer
The buzzer sounds to inform you that the VTrak needs attention. See “VTrak is
Beeping” on page 262 for more information.
You can silence the buzzer for the current trigger event.
To silence the Buzzer:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Enclosures
icon.
114
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
3.
Click the Enclosure
4.
Click on the Buzzer tab in Management View.
5.
icon.
Click the Mute button.
The buzzer goes silent. If another trigger event occurs, the buzzer will sound
again.
Making Buzzer Settings
To make buzzer settings:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Enclosures
icon.
3.
Click the Enclosure
4.
In Management View, from the Buzzer tab dropdown menu, choose
Settings.
5.
Check the Buzzer Enable box to enable the buzzer.
icon.
Uncheck the Buzzer Enable box if you do not want the buzzer to sound.
6.
Click the Submit button.
Testing the Buzzer
To test buzzer function:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Enclosures
icon.
3.
Click the Enclosure
4.
Click the Buzzer tab in Management View.
5.
icon.
Click the Sound button.
The buzzer will sound for one minute.
115
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Managing Physical Drives
Managing Physical Drives deals with the physical disk drives installed in the
VTrak subsystem enclosure, including the following functions:
•
Viewing a List of Physical Drives (page 116)
•
Identifying a Physical Drive (page 116)
•
Making Global Physical Drive Settings (page 116)
•
Viewing Physical Drive Information (page 117)
•
Viewing Physical Drive Statistics (page 118)
•
Making Physical Drive Settings (page 118)
•
Clearing Stale and PFA Conditions (page 119)
•
Forcing a Physical Drive Offline or Online (page 119)
Viewing a List of Physical Drives
To view a list of physical drives in this enclosure:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Enclosures
icon.
3.
Click the Enclosure
4.
Click the Physical Drives
icon.
icon.
The list of physical drives appears in Management View.
Identifying a Physical Drive
To identify physical drive in the VTrak subsystem enclosure:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Enclosures
icon.
3.
Click the Enclosure
4.
Click the Physical Drives
5.
In Management View, click the physical drives in the graphic.
icon.
icon.
The location of the physical drive is highlighted in the Enclosure Front View
diagram.
Making Global Physical Drive Settings
Global settings apply to all of the physical disk drives installed in the VTrak
subsystem enclosure. To make global physical drive settings:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
116
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
2.
Click the Enclosures
icon.
3.
Click the Enclosure
4.
Click the Physical Drives
5.
Click the Global Settings tab in Management View.
6.
Make the settings as needed.
icon.
icon.
For SATA drives, check the boxes to enable:
•
Write Cache
•
Read Look Ahead Cache
•
Command Queuing (for disk drives that support Command Queuing)
•
From the DMA Mode dropdown menu, select a DMA mode.
For SAS drives, check the boxes to enable:
7.
•
Write Cache
•
Read Look Ahead Cache
•
Command Queuing (for disk drives that support Command Queuing)
•
Read Cache
Click the Submit button.
The functions you enable here depend on whether the physical drives
support those functions. See “Viewing Physical Drive Information” on
page 117 to determine which functions a particular drive supports.
Viewing Physical Drive Information
To view physical drive information:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Enclosures
icon.
3.
Click the Enclosure
4.
Click the Physical Drives
icon.
5.
Click on a Physical Drive
icon.
icon.
Useful information provided here includes:
•
The location of the physical drive is highlighted in the Enclosure Front View
diagram.
•
Operational Status – OK is normal. Can also show Rebuilding, Forced
Online, Forced Offline, Transition Running, PDM Running, Media Patrol
Running, Stale, PFA, Offline, or Dead.
•
Configuration Status – The array to which the drive is assigned or its spare
designation, including Unconfigured, Stale, PFA, Global Spare, Dedicated
Spare, Revertible Global Spare, Revertible Dedicated Spare.
117
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Adjustable Items
•
Write Cache
•
Read Look Ahead Cache
•
Read Cache – SAS drive only
•
Command Queuing
•
DMA Mode – SATA drives only
See “Making Global Physical Drive Settings” on page 116.
Viewing Physical Drive Statistics
To view physical drive statistics:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Enclosures
icon.
3.
Click the Enclosure
4.
Click the Physical Drives
icon.
5.
Click on a Physical Drive
icon.
6.
From the dropdown menu on the Information tab, choose Statistics.
icon.
Clearing Statistics
To clear statistics, see “Clearing Statistics” on page 102.
Making Physical Drive Settings
An alias is the only setting you can make to an individual physical drive. All other
settings are global. See “Making Global Physical Drive Settings” on page 116.
To make physical drive settings:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Enclosures
icon.
3.
Click the Enclosure
4.
Click the Physical Drives
icon.
5.
Click on a Physical Drive
icon.
6.
Click the Settings tab in Management View.
7.
Type an alias into the Physical Drive Alias field.
icon.
Maximum of 32 characters. Use letters, numbers, space between words,
and underscore. An alias is optional.
8.
Click the Submit button.
118
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Clearing Stale and PFA Conditions
The Clear tab only appears when those conditions are present.
•
Stale – The physical drive contains obsolete disk array information.
•
PFA – The physical drive has errors resulting in a prediction of failure.
Be sure you have corrected the condition by a physical drive replacement, rebuild
operation, etc., first. Then clear the condition. See “Physical Drive Problems” on
page 293 for more information.
To clear a Stale or PFA status from a physical drive:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Enclosures
icon.
3.
Click the Enclosure
4.
Click the Physical Drives
icon.
5.
Click on a Physical Drive
icon.
6.
in Management View, click the Clear tab.
7.
In the Confirmation box, click OK to confirm.
icon.
Note
If a physical drive has both a Stale and a PFA condition, click the
Clear tab once to clear the Stale condition, then click again to clear
the PFA condition.
Forcing a Physical Drive Offline or Online
The Physical Drive–Force Offline/Online tab enables you to force an:
•
Online physical drive to go Offline
•
Offline physical drive to go Online
The Force Offline/Online tab appears only for physical drives that are assigned to
disk arrays.
Caution
Forcing a physical drive offline or online is likely to cause data
loss. Back up your data before you proceed. Use these functions
only when required.
119
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Important
Forcing a physical drive offline will cause your logical drives to
become degraded. If Auto Rebuild is enabled and a spare drive is
available, the disk array will begin rebuilding itself automatically.
To force a physical drive offline or online:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Enclosures
icon.
3.
Click the Enclosure
4.
Click the Physical Drives
icon.
5.
Click on a Physical Drive
icon.
6.
Click the Force Offline/Online tab in Management View.
icon.
7.
Click the Submit button.
8.
In the confirmation box, type the word confirm in the field provided.
9.
Click the OK button.
120
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Managing Disk Arrays
Disk Array Management includes the following functions:
•
Viewing Disk Arrays (page 121)
•
Creating a Disk Array (page 121)
•
Deleting a Disk Array (page 125)
•
Viewing Disk Array Information (page 126)
•
Making Disk Array Settings (page 127)
•
Creating a Logical Drive (page 127)
•
Deleting a Logical Drive (page 129)
•
Migrating a Disk Array (page 129)
•
Rebuilding a Disk Array (page 130)
•
Running PDM on a Disk Array (page 131)
•
Transitioning a Disk Array (page 132)
•
Preparing a Disk Array for Transport (page 132)
Viewing Disk Arrays
To view the disk arrays in this enclosure plus any expanded or cascaded
enclosures:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Disk Arrays
icon.
A list of disk arrays appears in Management View.
Click the DA link to view a specific disk array. See “Viewing Disk Array
Information” on page 126.
Creating a Disk Array
The CLU provides three methods of creating a disk array:
•
Automatic – Creates a default disk array and logical drive based on
unconfigured physical drives in the system. No user choices. See “Creating
a Disk Array – Automatic” on page 122.
•
Express – You select the RAID characteristics and type of application.
Creates a disk array and logical drive(s) based on your input. See “Creating
a Disk Array – Express” on page 122.
•
Advanced – You specify all parameters for a new disk array. One logical
drive will be made automatically when you create the disk array. If you select
less than the total available capacity, you can use the remaining space to
create additional logical drives at a later time. See “Creating a Disk Array –
Advanced” on page 123.
121
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Creating a Disk Array – Automatic
The Disk Array Automatic Creation option enables you to create a new disk array
following a default set of parameters. One logical drive will be made automatically
when you create the disk array. To create a Disk Array using the Automatic
function:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Disk Arrays
icon.
3.
Click the Create tab in Management View.
4.
From the Create tab dropdown menu, select Automatic.
The following parameters display:
5.
•
Disk Arrays – The number of physical drives in the disk array, their slot
numbers, configurable capacity, and the number of logical drives to be
created
•
Logical Drives – The ID number of the logical drive(s), their RAID level,
capacity, and stripe size
•
Spare Drives – The physical drive slot number of the dedicated hot
spare assigned to this disk array. A hot spare drive is created for all
RAID levels except RAID 0, when five or more unconfigured physical
drives are available
If you accept these parameters, click the Submit button.
The new disk array appears in the Disk Array List the Information tab.
If you do NOT accept these parameters, use the Advanced option to create
your disk array.
Creating a Disk Array – Express
The Disk Array Express Creation option enables you to choose the parameters
for a new disk array by specifying the characteristics you want. With this method,
you can create multiple logical drives at the same time you create your disk array.
However, all of the logical drives will be the same.
If you prefer to specific the parameters directly, use the Advanced option to
create your disk array.
If you are uncertain about choosing parameters for your disk array, use the
Automatic option.
To create a new disk array:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Disk Arrays
icon.
122
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
3.
Click the Create tab in Management View.
4.
From the Create tab dropdown menu, select Express.
5.
Check the boxes to select any one or combination of:
•
Redundancy – The array will remain available if a physical drive fails
•
Capacity – The greatest possible amount of data capacity
•
Performance – The highest possible read/write speed
•
Spare Drive – A hot spare drive is created when you select
Redundancy, Spare Drive, and five or more unconfigured physical
drives are available
6.
In the Number of Logical Drives field, enter the number of logical drives you
want to make from this disk array.
7.
From the Application Type menu, select an application that best describes
your intended use for this disk array:
8.
•
File Server
•
Video Stream
•
Transaction Data
•
Transaction Log
•
Other
Click the Update button.
Or check the Automatic Update box and updates will occur automatically.
The following parameters display:
•
Disk Arrays – The number of physical drives in the disk array, their slot
numbers, configurable capacity, and the number of logical drives to be
created
•
Logical Drives – The slot number of the logical drive(s), their RAID
level, capacity, and stripe size
•
Spare Drives – The physical drive slot number of the dedicated hot
spare assigned to this disk array (all RAID levels except RAID 0)
If you accept these parameters, proceed to the next step.
If you do NOT accept these parameters, review and modify your selections
in the previous steps.
9.
When you are done, click the Submit button.
The new disk array appears in the Disk Array List the Information tab.
Creating a Disk Array – Advanced
The Disk Array Advanced Creation option enables you to directly specify all
parameters for a new disk array. One logical drive will be made automatically
123
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
when you create the disk array. If you select less than the total available capacity,
you can use the remaining space to create additional logical drives at a later time.
If you are uncertain about choosing parameters for your disk array, use the
Express or Automatic option to create your disk array.
To create a new disk array:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Disk Arrays
icon.
3.
From the Create tab dropdown menu, select Advanced.
Step 1 – Disk Array Creation
4.
Enter an alias for the disk array in the field provided.
5.
Check the box if you want to enable Media Patrol.
For more information, see “Media Patrol” on page 255.
6.
Check the box if you want to enable PDM.
For more information, see “Predictive Data Migration (PDM)” on page 256.
7.
Highlight physical drives you want in the disk array from the Available list and
press the >> button to move them to the Selected list.
You can also double-click them to move them.
8.
When you are done, click the Next button.
Step 2 – Logical Drive Creation
Logical Drive Creation enables you to specify logical drives under the new disk
array. Enter the information for a logical drive, then click the Update button. If
there is free capacity remaining, you can specify another logical drive now or wait
until later.
9.
Enter an alias for the logical drive in the field provided.
10. Choose a RAID level for the logical drive from the dropdown menu.
The choice of RAID levels depends the number of physical drives you
selected.
11. RAID 50 and 60 only – Specify the number of axles for your array.
For more information on axles, see “RAID 50 Axles” on page 238 or “RAID
60 Axles” on page 240.
12. Specify a Capacity and the unit of measure (MB, GB, TB).
This value will be the data capacity of the first logical drive in your new disk
array. If you specify less than disk array's maximum capacity, the remainder
will be available for additional logical drives which you can create later.
13. Specify a Stripe size from the dropdown menu.
64 KB, 128 KB, 256 KB, and 1 MB are available. 64 KB is the default.
124
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
14. Specify a Sector size from the dropdown menu.
512 B, 1 KB, 2 KB, and 4 KB are available. 512 B is the default.
15. Specify a Read (cache) Policy from the dropdown menu.
Read Cache, Read Ahead Cache, and No Cache are available. Read Ahead
is the default.
16. Specify a Write (cache) Policy from the dropdown menu.
Write Back and Write Through (Thru) are available. Write Back is the default.
17. From the Preferred Controller ID dropdown menu, select a controller.
The choices are Controller 1 or 2, or Automatic. This feature is only available
on subsystems with two controllers and LUN Affinity enabled.
18. Click the Update button.
A new logical drive is displayed under New Logical Drives.
Repeat the above steps to specify additional logical drives as desired.
19. When you are done specifying logical drives, click the Next button.
Step 3 – Summary
The Summary lists the disk array and logical drive information you specified.
20. To proceed with disk array and logical drive creation, click the Submit
button.
The new disk array appears in the Disk Array List the Information tab.
Note
This function does not automatically create a hot spare drive. After
the disk array is created, you can create a hot spare drive for it.
For more information, see “Creating a Spare Drive” on page 142.
Deleting a Disk Array
The Disk Arrays–Delete tab enables you to delete existing disk arrays.
Caution
If you delete a disk array, you also delete any logical drives that
belong to it, along with the data in those logical drives. Back up
any important data before deleting a disk array.
To delete a disk array:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Disk Arrays
icon.
125
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
3.
Click the Delete tab in Management View.
4.
Check the box to the left of the disk array you want to delete.
5.
Click the Submit button.
6.
In the confirmation box, type the word confirm in the field provided.
7.
Click the OK button.
The selected disk array disappears from the Disk Array List the Information tab.
Viewing Disk Array Information
To view Disk Array information:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Disk Arrays
icon.
3.
Click the Disk Array
icon.
The disk array information is shown in Management View.
Disk Array Operational Status
•
OK – This is the normal state of a logical drive. When a logical drive is
Functional, it is ready for immediate use. For RAID Levels other than RAID 0
(Striping), the logical drive has full redundancy.
•
Synchronizing – This condition is temporary. Synchronizing is a maintenance
function that verifies the integrity of data and redundancy in the logical drive.
When a logical drive is Synchronizing, it will function and your data is
available. However, access will be slower due to the synchronizing
operation.
•
Critical/Degraded – This condition arises as the result of a physical drive
failure. A degraded logical drive will still function and your data is still
available. However, the logical drive has lost redundancy (fault tolerance).
You must determine the cause of the problem and correct it.
•
Rebuilding – This condition is temporary. When a physical drive has been
replaced, the logical drive automatically begins rebuilding in order to restore
redundancy (fault tolerance). When a logical drive is rebuilding, it will
function and your data is available. However, access will be slower due to
the rebuilding operation.
•
Transport Ready – After you perform a successful Prepare for Transport
operation, this condition means you can remove the physical drives of this
disk array and move them to another enclosure or different drive slots. After
you relocate the physical drives, the disk array status will show OK.
Adjustable Items
•
Alias – Optional.
126
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
•
Media Patrol – Enabled or disabled.
•
PDM – Enabled or disabled.
See “Making Disk Array Settings” on page 127.
Making Disk Array Settings
To make Disk Array settings:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Disk Arrays
icon.
3.
Click the Disk Array
4.
Click the Settings tab in Management View.
5.
Optional. Enter an alias in the Disk Array Alias field.
icon.
Maximum of 32 characters. Use letters, numbers, space between words,
and underscore. An alias is optional.
6.
To enable Media Patrol support, check the Media Patrol box.
7.
To enable PDM support, check the PDM box.
8.
Click the Submit button.
Creating a Logical Drive
When you create a disk array, you automatically create one logical drive also. If
the initial logical drive used less than the full capacity of the disk array, you can
create additional logical drives from the same disk array.
To create a logical drive:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Disk Arrays
icon.
3.
Click the Disk Array
4.
Click the Create LD tab in Management View.
5.
Enter an alias (name) in the Alias field.
icon.
Maximum of 32 characters. Use letters, numbers, space between words,
and underscore. An alias is optional.
6.
From the RAID Level dropdown list, select a RAID level for this logical drive.
All RAID levels supported by the disk array appear in the list. See “Choosing
a RAID Level” on page 242.
7.
RAID 50 and 60 only – Specify the number of axles for your array.
127
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
For more information on axles, see “RAID 50 Axles” on page 238 or “RAID
60 Axles” on page 240.
8.
Enter a capacity and select unit of measure (MB, GB, TB).
The default value is the available capacity of the disk array. You can use this
value or any lesser amount.
9.
From the Stripe dropdown menu, select a Stripe size for this logical drive.
The choices are 64 KB, 128 KB, 256 KB, 512 KB, and 1 MB. 64 KB is the
default. See “Choosing Stripe Size” on page 245.
10. From the Sector dropdown menu, select a Sector size for this logical drive.
The choices are 512 B, 1 KB, 2 KB, and 4 KB. 512 B is the default. See
“Choosing Sector Size” on page 245.
11. From the Read Policy dropdown menu, select a Read Cache policy for this
logical drive.
The choices are Read Cache, Read Ahead, and No (read) Cache. Read
Ahead is the default. See “Cache Policy” on page 246.
12. From the Write Policy dropdown menu, select a Write Cache policy for this
logical drive.
The choices are Write Through (thru) and Write Back. Write Back is the
default. If you selected No Cache under Read Cache, this setting will be
Write Through. See “Cache Policy” on page 246.
13. From the Preferred Controller ID dropdown menu, select a controller.
The choices are Controller 1 or 2, or Automatic. This feature is only available
on subsystems with two controllers and LUN Affinity enabled.
14. Click the Update button to enter the logical drive parameters.
15. Review the results. If there is remaining space the disk array, you can create
another logical drive, following the steps above. Each logical drive can have
a different set of parameters.
16. Click the Next button when you are done.
A new window displays with the disk array information and the proposed
logical drives with their parameters.
17. Click the Submit button create the logical drives.
The new logical drive appears in the Logical Drive List the Information tab.
If you created a fault-tolerant logical drive (any RAID level except RAID 0), the
Operational Status of new logical drive will display Synchronizing for several
minutes after creation. You can use the logical drive during this period but read/
write performance could be slower than normal.
128
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Deleting a Logical Drive
Caution
All data the logical drive will be lost. Back up any valuable data
before deleting the logical drive.
To delete a logical drive:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Disk Arrays
icon.
3.
Click the Disk Array
4.
Click the Delete LD tab in Management View.
5.
Check the box to the left of the logical drive you want to delete.
6.
icon.
Click the Submit button.
In the confirmation box, type the word confirm in the field provided.
7.
Click the OK button.
The selected logical disappears from the Logical Drive List the Information tab.
Migrating a Disk Array
The action of migrating a disk array means either or both:
•
Change the RAID Level
•
Expand the storage capacity
For a list of Migration options and other important information, see “RAID Level
Migration” on page 252.
Notes
•
You can add physical drives to a RAID 50 or RAID 60 array
but you cannot change the number of axles.
•
If you add an odd number of physical drives to a RAID 10
array, it will become a RAID 1E array by default.
To Migrate an existing disk array:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Disk Arrays
icon.
3.
Click the Disk Array
icon.
129
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
4.
From the dropdown menu the Background Activities tab, select Start
Migration.
5.
Highlight physical drives you want in the disk array from the Available list and
press the >> button to move them to the Selected list.
You can also double-click them to move them.
6.
When you are done, click the Next button.
7.
Select a new RAID Level, if desired.
8.
To expand the disk array's capacity, check the Expand Capacity box.
9.
If you checked the Expand Capacity box, enter a number into the Capacity
field and select the appropriate unit of measure (MB, GB, TB).
10. Under Capacity Usage, highlight the logical drive whose RAID level you want
to change or whose capacity you want to expand.
11. Click the Update button.
The logical drive changes to reflect your choices.
12. Update other logical drives using the same method.
13. When you are done making the changes, click the Next button.
14. Click the Submit button to begin Migration.
To set Migration priority, see “Making Background Activity Settings” on page 66.
Rebuilding a Disk Array
When you rebuild a disk array, you are actually rebuilding the data on a
replacement physical drive.
Rebuilding Automatically
Normally, a disk array would rebuild itself using a hot disk drive, after going
Critical. However, if the Auto Rebuild function is disabled or no spare drives are
available, you must initiate the procedure.
To enable Auto Rebuild, see “Making Background Activity Settings” on page 66.
To create a spare drive, see “Creating a Spare Drive” on page 142.
For more information, see “Hot Spare Drive(s)” on page 251.
Rebuilding Manually
If a physical drive has failed, identify and replace the drive, then rebuild the disk
array as described below:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Disk Arrays
icon.
3.
Click the Disk Array
icon.
130
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
If there are multiple disk arrays, choose the icon with the yellow !.
4.
From the dropdown menu the Background Activity tab, select Start Rebuild.
5.
Select the Source physical drive.
This is a remaining functional physical drive in the disk array.
6.
Select the Target physical drive.
This is the replacement physical drive.
7.
Click the Submit button.
The Disk Array Background Activity tab shows the rebuild progress on the
replacement (target) physical drive. Depending the size of the physical disk
involved, this process will take some time.
To view more information, click the Rebuild on PDx link.
To set Rebuild priority, see “Making Background Activity Settings” on page 66.
Running Media Patrol on a Disk Array
Media Patrol checks the magnetic media on physical drives. When it finds the
specified number of bad blocks, it will trigger PDM. See “Making Background
Activity Settings” on page 66 and “Running PDM” on page 68.
You can schedule Media Patrol to run automatically, see “Scheduling an Activity”
on page 69.
To start Media Patrol:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Disk Arrays
icon.
3.
Click the Disk Array
4.
From the dropdown menu the Background Activities tab, choose Start Media
Patrol.
5.
Click the Start button.
icon.
Running PDM on a Disk Array
Predictive Data Migration (PDM) migrates data from the suspect physical drive to
a spare physical drive, similar to Rebuilding. But unlike Rebuilding, PDM acts
before the disk drive fails and your Logical Drive goes Critical.
See “Predictive Data Migration (PDM)” on page 256.
To start PDM:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Disk Arrays
icon.
131
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
3.
Click the Disk Array
icon.
4.
Click the Background Activities tab in Management View.
5.
From the dropdown menu the Background Activities tab, choose Start PDM.
6.
In the next screen, select the Source and Target physical drives.
The suspect physical drive is the source. The replacement physical drive is
the target.
7.
Click the Start button.
Transitioning a Disk Array
Transition is the process of replacing a revertible spare drive that is currently part
of a disk array with an unconfigured physical drive or a non-revertible spare. The
revertible spare drive returns to its original status. For more information, see
“Transition” on page 257.
In order to run the Transition function:
•
The spare drive must be Revertible.
•
You must specify an unconfigured physical drive of the same or larger
capacity to replace the revertible spare drive.
To run Transition:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
From the dropdown menu on the Background Activities tab, select Start
Transition.
3.
Select an unconfigured physical drive from the list of available drives.
4.
From the Target Physical Drive dropdown menu, choose an unconfigured
physical drive.
5.
Click the Submit button.
After Transition is completed, refresh the screen. The revertible spare drive will
be listed under the Spare Drives icon and the disk array’s operational status will
show OK.
To set Transition priority, see “Making Background Activity Settings” on page 66.
Preparing a Disk Array for Transport
Transport is the action of moving the physical drives of a disk array:
•
To different slots in the same VTrak enclosure
•
From one VTrak enclosure to another
132
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Important
Before you can use this feature, the disk array’s Operational
Status must be OK.
To prepare a disk array for transport:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Disk Arrays
icon.
3.
Click the Disk Array
4.
Click the Transport tab in Management View.
icon.
5.
Click the Submit button.
6.
In the confirmation box, type the word confirm in the field provided.
7.
Click the OK button.
8.
After the Transition is complete, move the physical drives comprising the
disk array to their new locations.
9.
Click the Refresh button in your Browser.
The drives appear in their new locations and disk array status displays OK.
133
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Managing Logical Drives
Logical drives are made from disk arrays. In the Tree, you can see a graphic
representation of the logical drives that belong to each array. You can see a
summary of all logical drives in the subsystem under Logical Drive Summary.
Logical drive management includes the following functions:
•
Viewing Information for All Logical Drives (page 134)
•
Viewing Logical Drive Information (page 135)
•
Viewing Logical Drive Statistics (page 136)
•
Making Logical Drive Settings (page 136)
•
Initializing a Logical Drive (page 137)
•
Running Redundancy Check (page 137)
•
Viewing the Logical Drive Check Table (page 138)
•
Making Logical Drive LUN Settings (page 139)
Viewing Information for All Logical Drives
To view information about all logical drives in a disk array:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Disk Arrays
icon.
3.
Click the Disk Array
4.
Click the Logical Drives
icon.
icon
Logical Drive Status
•
OK – This is the normal state of a logical drive. When a logical drive is
Functional, it is ready for immediate use. For RAID Levels other than RAID 0
(Striping), the logical drive has full redundancy.
•
Synchronizing – This condition is temporary. Synchronizing is a maintenance
function that verifies the integrity of data and redundancy in the logical drive.
When a logical drive is Synchronizing, it will function and your data is
available. However, access will be slower due to the synchronizing
operation.
•
Rebuilding – This condition is temporary. When a physical drive has been
replaced, the logical drive automatically begins rebuilding in order to restore
redundancy (fault tolerance). When a logical drive is rebuilding, it will
function and your data is available. However, access will be slower due to
the rebuilding operation.
•
Critical – This condition arises as the result of a physical drive failure. A
degraded logical drive will still function and your data is still available.
134
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
However, the logical drive has lost redundancy (fault tolerance). You must
determine the cause of the problem and correct it.
•
Offline – This condition arises as the result of a second physical drive failure.
An Offline logical drive is not accessible but some or all of your data may
remain intact. You must determine the cause of the problem and correct it.
•
Transport Ready – After you perform a successful Prepare for Transport
operation, this condition means you can remove the physical drives of this
disk array and move them to another enclosure or different drive slots. After
you relocate the physical drives, the disk array status will show OK.
To create a logical drive, see “Creating a Logical Drive” on page 127.
To delete a logical drive, see “Deleting a Logical Drive” on page 129.
For a Degraded or Offline logical drive, see “Critical & Offline Disk Arrays” on
page 289.
Viewing Logical Drive Information
To view information for a single logical drive:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Disk Arrays
icon.
3.
Click the Disk Array
4.
Click the Logical Drives
5.
Click the Logical Drive
icon.
icon
icon.
To specify an Alias or set the Read and Write Policies, click the Settings tab.
Logical Drive Status
See “Logical Drive Status” on page 134.
Logical Drive Synchronization
Synchronization is an automatic procedure applied to logical drives when they
are created. Yes means the logical drive was synchronized.
Adjustable Items
•
Alias – Optional
•
Read Policy
•
Write Policy
•
Preferred Controller ID
See “Making Logical Drive Settings” on page 136.
135
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Viewing Logical Drive Statistics
To view information for a single logical drive:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Disk Arrays
icon.
3.
Click the Disk Array
4.
Click the Logical Drives
5.
Click the Logical Drive
6.
In Management View, click on the dropdown menu on the Information tab
and choose Statistics.
icon.
icon
icon.
Clearing Statistics
To clear statistics, see “Clearing Statistics” on page 102.
Making Logical Drive Settings
To make Logical Drive settings:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Disk Arrays
icon.
3.
Click the Disk Array
icon.
4.
Click the Logical Drives
5.
Click the Logical Drive
icon
6.
Click the Settings tab in Management View.
7.
Optional. Enter an alias in the Logical Drive Alias field.
icon.
Maximum of 32 characters. Use letters, numbers, space between words,
and underscore. An alias is optional.
8.
From the Read Policy dropdown menu, select a Read Cache policy.
The choices are Read Cache, Read Ahead, and No Cache.
9.
From the Write Policy dropdown menu, select a Write Cache policy.
The choices are Write Back and Write Through (Thru). If you select No Read
Cache, Write policy is automatically Write Through.
10. From the Preferred Controller ID dropdown menu, select the preferred
controller to access this logical drive.
The choices are 1 and 2. This feature is only available on subsystems with
two controllers and LUN Affinity enabled. If N/A is shown, there is only one
controller in the enclosure.
136
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
11. Click the Submit button.
Initializing a Logical Drive
Initialization is done to logical drives after they are created from a disk array.
Initialization sets all data bits in the logical drive to zero. The action is useful
because there may be residual data the logical drives left behind from earlier
configurations. For this reason, Initialization is recommended for all new logical
drives.
Caution
When you initialize a logical drive, all the data the logical drive will
be lost. Backup any important data before you initialize a logical
drive.
Initialize a Logical Drive:
1.
Click the Subsystem
2.
Click the Logical Drive Summary
icon in Tree View.
3.
Click the
icon.
icon of the logical drive you want to Initialize.
You can also start Initialization from the Subsystem
Activities tab
icon Background
4.
Click the Background Activities tab in Management View.
5.
From the Background Activities dropdown menu, select Initialization.
6.
To select Quick Initialization, check the box.
If you checked the box, enter a value in the Quick Initialization Size field.
This value is the size of the initialization blocks in MB.
7.
If you did not select Quick Initialization, enter a hexidecimal value in the
Initialization Pattern in Hex field or use the default 00000000 value.
8.
Click the Submit button.
9.
In the confirmation box, type the word confirm in the field provided.
10. Click the OK button.
To view the progress of the Initialization, click the Background Activity tab.
To set Initialization priority, see “Making Background Activity Settings” on
page 66.
Running Redundancy Check
Redundancy Check is a routine maintenance procedure for fault-tolerant logical
drives (those with redundancy) that ensures all the data matches exactly.
137
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Redundancy Check can also correct inconsistencies. You can also schedule a
Redundancy Check. See “Scheduling an Activity” on page 69.
Redundancy Check a Logical Drive:
1.
Click the Subsystem
2.
Click the Logical Drive Summary
icon in Tree View.
3.
Click the
icon.
icon of the logical drive you want to Initialize.
You can also start Redundancy check from the Subsystem
Background Activities tab
4.
5.
icon
From the dropdown menu on the Background Activities tab, select
Redundancy Check.
To select Auto Fix, check the box.
This feature attempts to repair the problem when it finds an error.
6.
To select Pause On Error, check the box.
This feature stops the process when it finds an error.
If Auto Fix is also checked, the process stops only when it finds a nonrepairable error.
7.
Click the Submit button.
To view the progress of the Redundancy Check, click the Background Activity
tab.
To set Redundancy Check priority, see “Making Background Activity Settings” on
page 66.
Viewing the Logical Drive Check Table
The Logical Drive Check Table displays errors related to a logical drive. Use this
information to evaluate the integrity of the logical drive and to determine whether
corrective action is needed. To View the tables:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Disk Arrays
icon.
3.
Click the Disk Array
4.
Click the Logical Drives
5.
Click the Logical Drive
6.
Click the Check Table tab in Management View.
7.
Click the option for the table you want to see.
icon.
icon
icon.
The default is All tables.
138
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
If there are entries, they are listed as follows:
•
Entry Number – A number assigned to each block of entry.
•
Table Type – Read Check, Write Check or Inconsistent Block (see
below).
•
Start Logical Block Address – LBA of the first block for this entry.
•
Count – Number of continuous blocks starting from this LBA.
Table Definitions
•
Read Check Table – Contains a list of read errors for this logical drive.
•
Write Check Table – Contains a list of write errors for this logical drive.
•
Inconsistent Block Table – Contains a list of inconsistent blocks for this
logical drive. Mirror data for RAID Levels 1, 1E, and 10 or Parity data for
RAID Levels 5, 6, 50, and 60 identified by the Redundancy Check (a
background function).
Making Logical Drive LUN Settings
For Fibre Channel and SAS, LUN Masking is the process of applying a LUN Map
so that each initiator can only access the LUNs specified for it.
Before you can specify an initiator for your LUN map, you must add the initiator to
the VTrak 's initiator list. See “Adding an Initiator” on page 83 or page 86.
You must enable LUN Masking in order apply a LUN map. See “Enabling LUN
Masking” on page 88.
To specify a LUN Map:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Disk Arrays
icon.
3.
Click the Disk Array
4.
Click the Logical Drives
5.
Click the Logical Drive
6.
Click the LUN Map tab in Management View.
7.
From the Unassigned Initiator List, click on an initiator to select it.
icon.
icon
icon.
Or type the initiator name into the Initiator Name field.
8.
Type a LUN into the Map to LUN field.
9.
Click the Assign button.
The initiator appears in the Assigned Initiator List.
10. Click the Submit button.
139
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Notes
•
Obtain the initiator name from the initiator utility on your host
system.
•
The initiator name you input must match exactly in order for
the connection to work.
LUN Mapping Parameters
•
Initiator Name
•
Fibre Channel – A Fibre Channel initiator name is the World Wide Port
Name of the device and is composed of a series of eight, two-digit
hexadecimal numbers.
•
SAS – A SAS initiator name is the SAS address of the HBA card in the
Host PC.
•
Alias – Optional. A common name for an iSCSI initiator
•
Symbolic Name – Optional. A common name for a Fibre Channel initiator
•
Port ID – Port ID of the Fibre Channel port for this initiator
•
LUN – Logical Unit Number on this logical drive for the selected initiator. You
must enter different LUN numbers for each logical drive.
140
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Managing Spare Drives
When a physical drive in a disk array fails and a spare drive of adequate capacity
is available, the disk array will begin to rebuild automatically using the spare
drive. See “Critical & Offline Disk Arrays” on page 289.
Spare drive management includes the following functions:
•
Viewing a List of Spare Drives (page 141)
•
Locating a Spare Drive (page 141)
•
Creating a Spare Drive (page 142)
•
Deleting Spare Drive (page 143)
•
Making Spare Drive Settings (page 143)
•
Running Spare Check (page 144)
Viewing a List of Spare Drives
To view a list of spare drives:
1.
Click the Subsystem
2.
Click the Spare Drives
icon in Tree View.
icon.
The information includes:
•
ID – The unique ID number assigned to the spare drive.
•
Operational Status – OK is normal. Can also show Rebuilding, Transition
Running, PDM Running, or Offline.
•
Physical Drive ID – The ID number of the physical drive in the subsystem
enclosure.
•
Capacity – The data storage capacity of this spare drive.
•
Revertible – Yes or No. A revertible spare drive automatically returns to its
spare drive assignment after the failed physical drive in the disk array is
replaced.
•
Type – Global, can be used by any disk array. Dedicated, can only be used
by the assigned disk array.
•
Dedicated to Array – For dedicated spares, the disk array to which it is
assigned. Global spares show N/A.
Locating a Spare Drive
To locate a physical drive assigned as a spare drive in the VTrak subsystem
enclosure:
1.
Click the Subsystem
2.
Click the Spare Drives
icon in Tree View.
icon.
141
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
3.
Click the Spare Drive
icon.
In Management View, the Enclosure Front View diagram appears with the
location of the spare drive highlighted.
Creating a Spare Drive
Important
•
There must be an unconfigured physical drive available for
selection as a spare drive. See “Viewing a List of Physical
Drives” on page 116.
•
Be sure the unconfigured physical drive has adequate
capacity to replace the largest drive in the disk array.
To create a spare drive:
1.
Click the Subsystem
2.
Click the Spare Drives
3.
Click the Create tab in Management View.
4.
icon in Tree View.
icon.
Select a spare type, Global or Dedicated.
Global can be used by any disk array. Dedicated can only be used by the
assigned disk arrays
5.
To make a revertible spare drive, check the Revertible box.
A revertible spare drive can be returned to spare drive status after it replaces
a failed drive in a disk array. See “Transition” on page 257 for more
information.
6.
In the Physical drives field, highlight the physical drive you want to assign as
a spare drive in the Available list and press the >> button to move the drive
to the Selected list.
You can also double-click drives to move them.
7.
If you selected a Dedicated spare drive, in the Dedicated to Disk Arrays field,
highlight disk arrays to which you want assign the spare drive from the
Available list and press the >> button to move the array to the Selected list.
You can also double-click arrays to move them.
8.
Click the Update button.
Your choices are displayed under New Hot Spare Drives.
9.
If you agree with the proposed choices, click the Submit button.
142
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Deleting Spare Drive
Note
If an existing spare drive has the wrong parameters for your
needs, click the Settings tab to change the parameters rather than
delete the spare drive and create a new one.
To delete a spare drive:
1.
Click the Subsystem
2.
Click the Spare Drives
3.
Click the Delete tab in Management View.
4.
Check the box to the left of the spare drive you want to delete.
5.
icon in Tree View.
icon.
Click the Submit button.
In the confirmation box, type the word confirm in the field provided.
6.
Click the OK button.
Making Spare Drive Settings
The Spare Drive–Settings tab enables you to change the settings of an existing
spare drive. To change spare drive settings:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Spare Drives
3.
Click the Spare Drive
icon.
4.
Click the Settings tab in Management View.
5.
Select a spare type, Global or Dedicated.
icon.
Global can be used by any disk array. Dedicated can only be used by the
assigned disk arrays
6.
To make a revertible spare drive, check the Revertible box.
A revertible spare drive automatically returns to its spare drive assignment
after the failed physical drive in the disk array is replaced.
7.
If you selected a Dedicated spare drive, in the Dedicated to Disk Arrays field,
highlight the disk arrays to which you want assign the spare drive from the
Available list and press the >> button to move them to the Selected list.
You can also double-click array to move it.
8.
Click the Submit button.
143
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Running Spare Check
Spare Check verifies the operational status of your spare drives. You can also
schedule a Spare Check. See “Scheduling an Activity” on page 69.
To check a spare drive:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Spare Drives
3.
Click the Spare Check tab in Management View.
4.
From the Physical Drive dropdown menu, select the spare drive you want to
check.
icon.
Or select All to check all the spare drives at the same time.
5.
Click the Submit button.
The results of the Spare Check appear under Spare Check Status in the
Information tab. “Healthy” means normal condition.
144
Chapter 4: Management with WebPAM PROe
Working with the Logical Drive Summary
The Logical Drive Summary displays a list of all logical drives in the VTrak
enclosure plus the expanded or cascaded enclosures. This list does not arrange
the logical drives under the disk array to which they belong nor under the
enclosure in which they are located.
Logical Drive Summary includes the following functions:
•
Viewing a List of All Logical Drives (page 145)
•
Viewing Individual Logical Drive Information (page 145)
Viewing a List of All Logical Drives
To view a list of all logical drives in all enclosures:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Drive Summary
icon.
Viewing Individual Logical Drive Information
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Drive Summary
3.
Click the Logical Drive
icon.
icon.
The information and location for the logical drive appear in Management
View. See Viewing Logical Drive Information (page 135).
145
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
146
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
This chapter covers the following topics:
•
Logging into the CLU (page 148)
•
Running Quick Setup (page 151)
•
•
Managing the Subsystem (page 152) •
Managing the Controllers (page 155) •
•
Managing the Enclosure (page 158)
•
Managing Physical Drives
(page 162)
•
Managing Disk Arrays (page 165)
•
Managing Logical Drives (page 176)
•
Managing the Network Connection
(page 179)
•
•
•
•
Working with the Event Viewer
(page 188)
Managing Spare Drives (page 190)
Working with LUN Mapping
(page 193)
•
Managing Users (page 196)
•
Working with Software Management
(page 199)
•
Flashing through TFTP (page 206)
•
Clearing Statistics (page 207)
•
Managing Fibre Channel
Connections (page 181)
Restoring Factory Defaults
(page 208)
•
Managing SAS Connections
(page 184)
Shutting Down the Subsystem
(page 209)
•
Restarting the Subsystem (page 211)
•
Making Buzzer Settings (page 212)
Managing Background Activity
(page 186)
For information about VTrak’s audible alarm and LEDs, see “Chapter 8:
Troubleshooting” on page 261.
147
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Logging into the CLU
There are two connections methods for the CLU:
•
Serial – Requires a null-modem cable to connect the serial ports on the Host
PC and VTrak
•
Telnet – Requires a network connection between the Host PC and VTrak’s
Management Port
Making a Serial Connection
Before you begin, be sure the null modem cable is connected between the Host
PC and VTrak, and that both machines are booted and running. Then do the
following actions:
1.
Start your PC’s terminal emulation program.
2.
Press Enter once to launch the CLU.
Making a Telnet Connection
If your Telnet connection has not been setup, refer to “Making Serial Cable
Connections” on page 32.
To start the telnet program:
1.
Go to the command line prompt (Windows) or click the terminal icon (Linux),
then run:
telnet 192.168.1.56 2300
The IP address above is only an example. Use your VTrak's Management
port IP address. 2300 is the Telnet port for the VTrak.
The telnet login screen appears:
2.
At the Login prompt, type the user name and press Enter.
The default user name is administrator.
3.
At the Password prompt, type the password and press Enter.
The default password is password.
The CLI screen appears.
4.
At the CLI prompt, type menu and press Enter
The CLU Main Menu appears.
148
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
Figure 4. The CLU main menu
Quick Setup – A sequence of four steps to setup System Date & Time,
Management Port, and RAID Configuration.
Subsystem Management – View controller information, lock/unlock the
controller, set date and time, and monitor the enclosure.
Physical Drive Management – View disk drive assignments and parameters,
change disk drive cache settings and command queuing, and locate a physical
drive.
Disk Array Management – View disk array information, create and delete disk
arrays, transport, rebuild, PDM, and transition functions, and locate a disk array,
create and delete logical drives.
Logical Drive Management – View logical drive information, name logical
drives, initialization and redundancy check, and locate a logical drive.
Network Management – Set IP addresses for Management Port, gateway, and
DNS server; subnet mask.
Fibre Channel Management – Node information, Port information, settings and
statistics, list of logged-in devices, list of initiators.
SAS Management – Node information, Port information, settings, status, and
statistics; SFP information, list initiators.
149
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Background Activity – Settings for Media Patrol, Auto Rebuild, Rebuild,
Migration, PDM, Transition, Synchronization, Initialization, Redundancy Check
rate, and thresholds.
Event Viewer – View the event logs.
Additional Info and Management – Spare Drives, LUN Mapping, User
management, EMail, SLP, Webserver, Telnet, SNMP, CIM, and Netsend
settings, firmware flash, clear statistics and restore factory default settings.
Buzzer – Enable, disable or silence the buzzer (audible alarm).
Accessing Online Help
To access online help on any CLU screen, press Ctrl-E.
To return to the CLU, press Enter.
Logging out of the CLU
1.
Highlight Return to Previous Menu and press Enter.
Repeat this action until you arrive at the Main Menu.
2.
From the Main Menu, highlight Return to CLI and press Enter to exit
3.
Close the terminal emulation, Telnet or terminal window.
150
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
Running Quick Setup
Quick Setup is discussed under “Setting up the Serial Connection” on page 35.
151
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Managing the Subsystem
Subsystem Management includes the following functions:
•
Setting an Alias for the Subsystem (page 152)
•
Setting Redundancy for the Subsystem (page 152)
•
Setting Cache Mirroring for the Subsystem (page 152)
•
Running Media Patrol (page 153)
•
Locking or Unlocking the Subsystem (page 153)
•
Setting Subsystem Date and Time (page 154)
Setting an Alias for the Subsystem
An alias is optional. To set an Alias for this subsystem:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Subsystem Management and press Enter.
2.
Type and alias into the Alias field.
Maximum of 48 characters. Use letters, numbers, space between words
and underscore.
3.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
Setting Redundancy for the Subsystem
This feature applies to models with dual controllers.
To set redundancy:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Subsystem Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Redundancy Type and press the spacebar to toggle between
Active-Active and Active-Standby.
3.
•
Active-Active – Both RAID controllers are active and can share the load
•
Active-Standby – One RAID controller is in standby mode and goes
active if the other fails
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
Setting Cache Mirroring for the Subsystem
This option applies only to subsystems with two controllers. To use Cache
Mirroring, the Redundancy Type must be set to Active-Active.
To change Cache Mirroring for this subsystem:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Subsystem Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Redundancy Type and press the spacebar to toggle between
Active-Active and Active-Standby.
152
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
3.
Highlight Cache Mirroring and press the spacebar to toggle between
Enabled and Disabled.
4.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
5.
Restart the subsystem.
See “Restarting the Subsystem” on page 211.
Notes
•
If you disable Cache Mirroring, LUN Affinity will be enabled
automatically.
•
If you change Cache Mirroring, be sure both controllers are
properly installed in the subsystem before you restart.
Running Media Patrol
Media Patrol is a routine maintenance procedure that checks the magnetic media
on each disk drive. Media Patrol checks all physical drives assigned to disk
arrays and spare drives. It does not check unconfigured drives.
To start, stop, pause or resume Media Patrol:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Subsystem Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Media Patrol and press enter.
3.
Highlight Start, Stop, Pause, or Resume and press Enter.
4.
If you chose Stop, press Y to confirm.
Locking or Unlocking the Subsystem
The lock prevents other sessions (including by the same user) from making a
configuration change to the controller until the lock expires or a forced unlock is
done. When the user who locked the controller logs out, the lock is automatically
released.
Setting the Lock
To set the lock:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Subsystem Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Lock Management and press Enter.
3.
In the Lock Time field, type a lock time in minutes.
1440 minutes = 24 hours
4.
Highlight Lock and press Enter.
153
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Resetting the Lock
To reset the lock with a new time:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Subsystem Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Lock Management and press Enter.
3.
In the Lock Time field, type a lock time in minutes.
1 to 1440 minutes (24 hours)
4.
Highlight Renew and press Enter.
Releasing the Lock
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Subsystem Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Lock Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Unlock and press Enter.
Releasing a Lock set by another user
To release somebody else’s lock:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Subsystem Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Lock Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Force Unlock and press the Spacebar to change to Yes.
4.
Highlight Unlock and press Enter.
Setting Subsystem Date and Time
Use this screen to make Date and Time settings:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Subsystem Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Modify System Date and Time and press Enter.
3.
Highlight the System Date or System Time setting.
4.
Press the backspace key to erase the current value.
5.
Type in a new value.
6.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
154
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
Managing the Controllers
Controller Management includes the following functions:
•
Viewing Controller Information (page 155)
•
Clearing an Orphan Watermark (page 155)
•
Making Controller Settings (page 156)
•
Locating the Controller (page 157)
Viewing Controller Information
Controller Management includes information, settings and statistics.
To access Controller Management:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Subsystem Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Controller Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight the controller you want and press Enter.
Basic Controller information displays.
To access additional controller information, highlight Advanced Information and
press Enter.
To access controller statistics, highlight Controller Statistics and press Enter.
Clearing an Orphan Watermark
This condition is the result of a disk drive failure during an NVRAM RAID level
migration on a disk array.
To clear an orphan watermark:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Subsystem Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Controller Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight one of the controllers and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Clear Orphan Watermark and press Enter.
The condition is cleared. See “Physical Drive Failed” on page 293 for more
information.
155
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Making Controller Settings
If your subsystem has two controllers, any settings you make to one controller
will automatically apply to the other controller.
To make Controller settings:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Subsystem Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Controller Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight the controller you want and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Controller Settings and press Enter.
5.
Make the following settings as required:
•
Type and alias into the Alias field.
Maximum of 48 characters. Use letters, numbers, space between words
and underscore. An alias is optional.
•
Highlight LUN Affinity and press the spacebar to toggle between
Enabled and Disabled.
If your subsystem has two controllers and Cache Mirroring is disabled,
LUN Affinity is enabled automatically.
•
Highlight Coercion and press the spacebar to toggle between Enabled
and Disabled.
•
Highlight Coercion Method and press the spacebar to toggle through:
GB Truncate – Reduces the capacity to the nearest 1 GB boundary
10 GB Truncate – Reduces the capacity to the nearest 10 GB boundary
Grp (group) Rounding – Uses an algorithm to determine truncation.
Results in the maximum amount of usable drive capacity
Table Rounding – Applies a predefined table to determine truncation
6.
•
Highlight Cache Flush Interval and press the backspace key to erase
the current value. Type a new interval value (1 to 12 seconds).
•
Highlight SMART and press the spacebar to toggle between Enable and
Disable.
•
Highlight SMART Poll Interval and press the backspace key to erase the
current value. Type a new interval value (1 to 1440 minutes).
•
Highlight Poll Interval and press the backspace key to erase the current
value. Type a new interval value (15 to 255 seconds).
•
Highlight Adaptive Writeback Cache and press the spacebar to toggle
between Enabled and Disabled.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
156
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
Locating the Controller
To locate this controller:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Subsystem Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Controller Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight the controller you want and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Controller Settings and press Enter.
5.
Highlight Locate Controller and press Enter.
Controller Dirty Cache
LED and Status
Controller, will flash for one minute.
157
LED, on the back of the
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Managing the Enclosure
Enclosure Management includes the following functions:
•
Viewing Enclosure Information (page 158)
•
Viewing Power Supply Status (page 158)
•
Locating a Power Supply (page 159)
•
Viewing Blower Status (page 159)
•
Viewing Voltage Sensor Status (page 159)
•
Viewing Temperature Sensor Status (page 159)
•
Setting Temperature Thresholds (page 160)
•
Checking the Batteries (page 160)
•
Reconditioning a Battery (page 161)
•
Locating an Enclosure (page 161)
•
Viewing Enclosure Topology (page 161)
Viewing Enclosure Information
Enclosure Management includes information, status, settings and location. To
access Enclosure Management:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Subsystem Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Enclosure Management and press Enter.
To access FPU VPD information (vital product data on field replaceable units),
highlight FPU VPD Information and press Enter.
To access the current status of the power supplies, blowers, temperature or
voltage sensors, highlight the item you want and press Enter.
Viewing Power Supply Status
To view the status of the power supplies:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Subsystem Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Enclosure Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Power Supplies and press Enter.
The screen displays the operational and fan status of VTrak’s two power
supplies. If any status differs from normal or the fan speed is below the Healthy
Threshold value, there is a fan/power supply malfunction. See “Replacing a
Power Supply” on page 218.
158
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
Locating a Power Supply
To locate a power supply:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Subsystem Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Enclosure Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Power Supplies and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Locate Power Supply and press Enter.
The LED on the selected power supply blinks for one minute.
Viewing Blower Status
To view the status of the blowers:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Subsystem Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Enclosure Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Blowers and press Enter.
The screen displays the status and speed of VTrak’s blowers. There is one
blower in each cooling unit. If blower speed is below the Healthy Threshold, there
is a blower malfunction. See “Replacing a Cooling Unit Fan or Blower” on
page 219.
Viewing Voltage Sensor Status
To view the status of the voltage sensors:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Subsystem Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Enclosure Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Voltage Sensors and press Enter.
If any voltage is outside the Healthy Threshold values, there is a voltage
malfunction in the enclosure. See “Chapter 8: Troubleshooting” on page 261.
Viewing Temperature Sensor Status
To view the status of the temperature sensors:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Subsystem Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Enclosure Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Temperature Sensors and press Enter.
If any temperature exceeds the Healthy Threshold value, there is an overheat
condition in the enclosure. See “Setting Temperature Thresholds” on page 160
and “Chapter 8: Troubleshooting” on page 261.
159
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Setting Temperature Thresholds
To change temperature thresholds:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Subsystem Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Enclosure Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Enclosure Settings and press Enter.
4.
Highlight the Temperature Warning threshold you want to change.
5.
Press the backspace key to erase the current value.
6.
Type a new interval value in degrees C.
7.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
Checking the Batteries
This feature enables you monitor and recondition the subsystem battery or
batteries.
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Subsystem Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Enclosure Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Batteries and press Enter.
4.
Highlight the battery you want to monitor and press Enter.
Battery Notes
Each battery works with a controller. If the battery is present in the subsystem but
the corresponding controller is not present, the battery will not appear in the
interface.
If a battery does not reflect normal conditions and it is not currently under
reconditioning, run the Recondition function before you replace the battery. See
“Reconditioning a Battery” on page 161.
Reconditioning fully discharges, then fully recharges the battery. During
reconditioning, if the Adaptive Writeback Cache function is enabled, the controller
cache is set to Write Thru. After reconditioning, the cache is reset to Write Back.
See “Making Controller Settings” on page 156.
If a battery reaches the threshold temperature while charging or discharging, the
charge or discharge pauses and the blower runs at high speed until the battery
temperature falls below the threshold.
If the battery does not maintain normal values after a Recondition, replace the
battery. See “Replacing a Cache Battery” on page 224.
VTrak automatically reconditions the battery every two months.
When you install a new battery, the cycle count shows 0. VTrak automatically
runs a recondition on the battery to verify it. If you restart the subsystem or
160
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
controller before reconditioning is finished, the battery is charged to 100%, then
reconditioning starts again.
Reconditioning a Battery
To recondition the subsystem battery:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Subsystem Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Enclosure Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Batteries and press Enter.
4.
Highlight the battery you want to recondition and press Enter.
5.
Highlight Start Reconditioning and press Enter.
6.
Press Y to confirm.
Reconditioning fully discharges, then fully recharges the battery. During
reconditioning, if the Adaptive Writeback Cache function is enabled, the
controller cache is set to Write Thru. After reconditioning, the cache is reset
to Write Back. See “Making Controller Settings” on page 156.
Locating an Enclosure
This feature helps you identify the physical VTrak enclosure you are working with
through the CLU.
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Subsystem Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Enclosure Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Locate Enclosure and press Enter.
The LEDs on the front of the VTrak will blink for one minute.
Viewing Enclosure Topology
This feature displays the connection topology of the VTrak subsystem. Topology
refers to the manner in which the data paths among the enclosures are
connected. There are three methods:
•
Individual Subsystem
•
JBOD Expansion – Managed through one subsystem or head unit
•
RAID Subsystem Cascading – Managed through one subsystem or head
unit
For more information, see “Making Management and Data Connections” on
page 21.
To view enclosure topology:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Subsystem Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Enclosure Topology and press Enter.
161
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Managing Physical Drives
Physical Drive Management includes the following functions:
•
Making Global Physical Drive Settings (page 162)
•
Setting an Alias (page 163)
•
Viewing Advanced Information (page 163)
•
Viewing Physical Drive Statistics (page 163)
•
Clearing Stale and PFA Conditions (page 163)
•
Forcing a Physical Drive Offline or Online (page 164)
•
Locating a Physical Drive (page 164)
Making Global Physical Drive Settings
All physical drive settings are made globally, except for setting an alias, which
applies to individual drives.
To make global physical drive settings:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Physical Drive Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Global Physical Drives Settings and press Enter.
3.
Change the following settings as required.
For SATA drives:
•
Highlight Write Cache and press the spacebar to toggle between
Enabled and Disabled.
•
Highlight Read Look Ahead Cache and press the spacebar to toggle
between Enabled and Disabled.
•
Highlight CmdQueuing and press the spacebar to toggle between
Enabled and Disabled.
•
Highlight DMA Mode and press the spacebar to toggle through UDMA
0–5 and MDMA 0–2.
For SAS drives:
4.
•
Highlight Write Cache and press the spacebar to toggle between
Enabled and Disabled.
•
Highlight Read Look Ahead Cache and press the spacebar to toggle
between Enabled and Disabled.
•
Highlight CmdQueuing and press the spacebar to toggle between
Enabled and Disabled.
•
Highlight Read Cache and press the spacebar to toggle between
Enabled and Disabled.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
162
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
Setting an Alias
An alias is optional. To set an Alias for a physical drive:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Physical Drive Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the physical drive of your choice and press Enter.
3.
Type an alias into the Alias field.
Maximum of 32 characters. Use letters, numbers, space between words
and underscore.
4.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
Viewing Advanced Information
To view advanced information about the selected physical drive:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Physical Drive Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the physical drive of your choice and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Advanced Information and press Enter.
Viewing Physical Drive Statistics
To view the statistics for the selected physical drive:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Physical Drive Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the physical drive of your choice and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Physical Drive Statistics and press Enter.
Clearing Stale and PFA Conditions
The Clear Stale and Clear PFA functions only appear when those conditions
exist on the physical drive. To clear a Stale or PFA condition on a physical drive:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Physical Drive Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the physical drive of your choice and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Clear Stale or Clear PFA and press Enter.
If a physical drive is still online and shows a PFA error but “Clear PFA” does not
appear, use PDM to copy the data to a new physical drive. Go to Disk Array Info
and Settings.
If a physical drive is offline and shows a PFA error, rebuild the disk array. Go to
Disk Array Info and Settings. After rebuilding, the drive will show Stale. Run Clear
Stale then run Clear PFA.
If the physical drive with a PFA error is a spare, you must delete the drive as a
spare, then Clear PFA will be available.
163
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
After you clear a PFA error, watch for another PFA error to appear. If it does,
replace the physical drive.
Forcing a Physical Drive Offline or Online
This function enables you to force an:
•
Online physical drive to go Offline
•
Offline physical drive to go Online
The Force Offline/Online function appears only for physical drives that are
assigned to disk arrays.
Caution
Forcing a physical drive offline or online is likely to cause data
loss. Back up your data before you proceed. Use these functions
only when required.
To force a physical drive offline or online:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Physical Drive Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Global Physical Drives Settings and press Enter.
3.
Highlight the physical drive of your choice and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Force Offline or Force Online and press Enter.
5.
Press Y to confirm.
Locating a Physical Drive
This feature helps you identify a physical drive within the VTrak enclosure you
are working with through the CLU. To locate a physical drive:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Physical Drive Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Global Physical Drives Settings and press Enter.
3.
Highlight the physical drive of your choice and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Locate Physical Drive and press Enter.
The drive carrier LEDs on the front of the VTrak will blink for one minute.
164
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
Managing Disk Arrays
Disk Array Management includes the following functions:
•
Creating a Disk Array (page 165)
•
Deleting a Disk Array (page 169)
•
Viewing Disk Array Information (page 170)
•
Setting an Alias for a Disk Array (page 170)
•
Enabling Media Patrol on a Disk Array (page 171)
•
Enabling PDM on a Disk Array (page 171)
•
Preparing the Disk Array for Transport (page 171)
•
Rebuilding a Disk Array (page 172)
•
Migrating a Disk Array (page 172)
•
Running PDM (page 173)
•
Running Transition on a Disk Array (page 173)
•
Locating a Disk Array (page 174)
•
Locating a Disk Array (page 174)
•
Creating a Logical Drive (page 174)
•
Deleting a Logical Drive (page 175)
Creating a Disk Array
The CLU provides three methods of creating a disk array:
•
Automatic – Creates a default disk array and logical drive based on
unconfigured physical drives in the system. No user choices. See “Creating
a Disk Array – Automatic” on page 166.
•
Express – You select the RAID characteristics and type of application.
Creates a disk array and logical drive(s) based on your input. See “Creating
a Disk Array – Express” on page 167.
•
Advanced – You specify all parameters for a new disk array. One logical
drive will be made automatically when you create the disk array. If you select
less than the total available capacity, you can use the remaining space to
create additional logical drives at a later time. See “Creating a Disk Array –
Advanced” on page 168.
165
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Creating a Disk Array – Automatic
To create a disk array using the Automatic feature:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Disk Array Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Create New Array and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Configuration Method and press the spacebar to toggle to
Automatic.
4.
Review the proposed configuration of disk array and logical drive(s).
•
To accept the proposed configuration and create the disk array and
logical drive(s), highlight Save Configuration and press Enter.
•
To reject the proposed configuration, highlight Cancel Array
Configuration and press Enter. You will return to the Disk Arrays
Summary screen.
To create a disk array with different characteristics, repeat the steps
above specifying different parameters but choose the Express or
Advanced option.
166
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
Creating a Disk Array – Express
To create a disk array using the Express feature:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Disk Array Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Create New Array and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Configuration Method and press the spacebar to toggle to Express.
4.
Highlight Configuration Method and press to spacebar to select each of the
following characteristics for your disk array:
•
Redundancy
•
Capacity
•
Performance
•
Spare Drive
5.
Highlight Number of Logical Drives and press the backspace key to erase
the current value.
6.
Enter the number of logical drives you want.
7.
Highlight Application Type and press the spacebar to toggle though the
applications and select the best one for your disk array.
•
File Server
•
Video Stream
•
Transaction Data
•
Transaction Log
•
Other
8.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings and move to the next screen.
9.
Review the proposed configuration of disk array and logical drive(s).
To accept the proposed configuration and create the disk array and logical
drive(s), highlight Save Configuration and press Enter.
To reject the proposed configuration, highlight Cancel Array Configuration
and press Enter. You will return to the Disk Arrays Summary screen.
To create a disk array with different characteristics, highlight Create New
Array and press Enter. Repeat the steps above specifying different
parameters.
167
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Creating a Disk Array – Advanced
For more information on the choices below, see “Chapter 7: Technology
Background” on page 231. To create a disk array using the Advanced feature:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Disk Array Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Create New Array and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Configuration Method and press the spacebar to toggle to
Advanced.
4.
Choose whether to enable Media Patrol and PDM.
5.
If you want to specify an alias to the disk array, highlight Alias and type a
name.
Maximum of 32 characters. Use letters, numbers, space between words and
underscore.
6.
Highlight Save Settings and Continue and press Enter.
7.
Highlight a physical drive you want to add to your array and press the
spacebar to select it.
Repeat this action until you have selected all the physical drives for your
array.
8.
Highlight Save Settings and Continue and press Enter.
9.
If you want to specify an alias to the logical drive, highlight Alias and type a
name.
Maximum of 32 characters. Use letters, numbers, space between words and
underscore.
10. Highlight RAID Level and press the spacebar to toggle though a list of
available RAID levels.
11. If you want to create multiple logical drives, highlight Capacity, press the
backspace key to remove the current value, then type a new smaller value.
12. Highlight Number of Axles and press the spacebar to select the number of
axles. Applies to RAID 50 and 60 only.
13. Highlight Stripe and press the spacebar to toggle through stripe sizes and
select 64 KB, 128 KB, 256 KB, 512 KB, or 1 MB.
14. Highlight Sector and press the spacebar to toggle through sector sizes and
select 512 B, 1 KB, 2 KB, or 4 KB.
15. Highlight Write Policy and press the spacebar to toggle write cache policy
between WriteBack and WriteThru (write though).
16. Highlight Read Policy and press the spacebar to toggle read cache policy
though ReadCache, ReadAhead, and NoCache.
17. Highlight Preferred Controller ID and press the spacebar to toggle among 1,
2, or Automatic. Applies to dual-controller capable Fibre Channel models
only.
168
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
18. Highlight Save Logical Drive and press Enter.
19. Review logical drive(s) you are about to create for your new array. Then do
one of the following actions:
•
If you agree with the logical drive(s) as specified, highlight Complete
Disk Array Creation and press Enter. A note will appear to remind you to
set up LUN mapping for your new logical drive(s). Press any key to
continue.
•
If you specified less than the full capacity for the logical drive in the
previous screen, and you want to add another logical drive now,
highlight Create New Logical Drive and press Enter.
•
If you do not agree with the logical drive(s), highlight Return to Previous
Screen and press Enter to begin the process again.
Deleting a Disk Array
Caution
When you delete a disk array, you delete all the logical drives and
the data they contain. Back up all important data before deleting a
disk array.
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Disk Array Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the disk array you want to delete and press the spacebar to mark it.
The mark is an asterisk (*) to the left of the listing.
3.
Highlight Delete Marked Arrays and press Enter.
4.
Press Y to confirm the deletion.
169
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Viewing Disk Array Information
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Disk Array Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the disk array you want and press Enter.
3.
Highlight any of the following and press Enter to view a list of:
The information and settings screen appears.
•
Spare drives in this array, dedicated and global
•
Physical drives in this array
•
Logical drives in this array
Disk Array Operational Status
•
OK – This is the normal state of a logical drive. When a logical drive is
Functional, it is ready for immediate use. For RAID Levels other than RAID 0
(Striping), the logical drive has full redundancy.
•
Synchronizing – This condition is temporary. Synchronizing is a
maintenance function that verifies the integrity of data and redundancy in the
logical drive. When a logical drive is Synchronizing, it will function and your
data is available. However, access will be slower due to the synchronizing
operation.
•
Critical/Degraded – This condition arises as the result of a physical drive
failure. A degraded logical drive will still function and your data is still
available. However, the logical drive has lost redundancy (fault tolerance).
You must determine the cause of the problem and correct it.
•
Rebuilding – This condition is temporary. When a physical drive has been
replaced, the logical drive automatically begins rebuilding in order to restore
redundancy (fault tolerance). When a logical drive is rebuilding, it will
function and your data is available. However, access will be slower due to
the rebuilding operation.
•
Transport Ready – After you perform a successful Prepare for Transport
operation, this condition means you can remove the physical drives of this
disk array and move them to another enclosure or different drive slots. After
you relocate the physical drives, the disk array status will show OK.
Setting an Alias for a Disk Array
This function sets an alias for the disk array. To set an alias:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Disk Array Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the disk array you want and press Enter.
3.
To set an alias for this disk array, highlight Alias and type an alias into the
field.
170
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
Maximum of 32 characters. Use letters, numbers, space between words and
underscore. An alias is optional.
4.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
Accepting an Incomplete Array
This condition is the result of a missing physical drive. See “Incomplete Array” on
page 292 before you use this function.
To accept an incomplete array:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Disk Array Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the disk array you want and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Accept Incomplete Array and press Enter.
Enabling Media Patrol on a Disk Array
Media Patrol checks the magnetic media on physical drives.
To run Media Patrol on a disk array:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Disk Array Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the disk array you want and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Media Patrol and press the spacebar to toggle between Enable
and Disable.
4.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
Enabling PDM on a Disk Array
This function enables and disables Predictive Data Migration (PDM).
To enable or disable PDM:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Disk Array Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the disk array you want and press Enter.
3.
Highlight PDM and press the spacebar to toggle between Enable and
Disable.
4.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
See “Running PDM” on page 173.
Preparing the Disk Array for Transport
To run the Transport function on a disk array:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Disk Array Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the disk array you want and press Enter.
171
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
3.
Highlight Transport and press Enter.
4.
Press Y to confirm.
Rebuilding a Disk Array
Before you can rebuild, you must have a replacement physical drive of adequate
capacity or your disk array. To rebuild a disk array:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Disk Array Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the disk array you want and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Background Activities and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Rebuild and press Enter.
5.
Specify the source and target physical drives.
6.
Highlight Start and press Enter.
Migrating a Disk Array
In order to migrate RAID level, you may have to add physical drives. For more
information, see “RAID Level Migration” on page 252.
To migrate a disk array:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Disk Array Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the disk array you want and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Background Activities and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Migration and press Enter.
5.
Highlight the physical drive you want to add and press the spacebar to select
it.
Repeat this action to add more physical drives.
Notes
•
You can add physical drives to a RAID 50 or 60 array but you
cannot change the number of axles.
•
If you add an odd number of physical drives to a RAID 10
array, it will become a RAID 1E array by default.
6.
Highlight Save Settings and Continue and press Enter.
7.
To change RAID level, Highlight the logical drive in the list and press Enter.
8.
Highlight RAID Level and press the spacebar to toggle through the available
RAID levels.
9.
Optional. If you want to increase capacity, highlight Expand Capacity and
press the spacebar to toggle to Yes.
172
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
10. Optional. If you want to increase capacity, highlight Capacity, press the
backspace key to erase the current logical drive capacity and type in the new
value.
The new value must be equal or larger than the current capacity.
11. Highlight Save Logical Drive and press Enter.
The screen returns to Disk Array Migration Logical Drives.
12. Highlight Complete Disk Array Migration and press Enter.
13. In the confirmation message, press Y to confirm.
The screen jumps to Disk Arrays Summary.
Running PDM
Be sure PDM must be enabled. See “Enabling PDM on a Disk Array” on
page 171.
To run Predictive Data Migration on a disk array:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Disk Array Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the disk array you want and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Background Activities and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Predictive Data Migration and press Enter.
5.
Specify the source and target physical drives.
6.
Highlight Start and press Enter.
Running Transition on a Disk Array
Transition is the process of replacing a revertible spare drive that is currently part
of a disk array with an unconfigured physical drive or a non-revertible spare drive.
For more information, see “Transition” on page 257.
In order to run Transition:
•
The spare drive must be Revertible.
•
You must have an unconfigured physical drive of the same or larger capacity
to replace the spare drive.
To run Transition on a disk array:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Disk Array Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the disk array you want and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Background Activities and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Transition and press Enter.
5.
Specify the source and target physical drives.
6.
Highlight Start and press Enter.
173
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Locating a Disk Array
This feature helps you identify the physical drives assigned to the disk array you
are working with in the CLU.
To locate a disk array:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Disk Array Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the disk array you want and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Locate Disk Array and press Enter.
The drive carrier LEDs pertaining to this disk array will blink for one minute.
Creating a Logical Drive
You can create logical drives on existing disk arrays if there is available space in
the array. For more information on the choices below, see “Chapter 7:
Technology Background” on page 231.
To create a logical drive from an existing disk array:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Disk Array Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the disk array in which you want to create a logical drive and press
Enter.
3.
Highlight Create New Logical Drive and press Enter.
The Disk Array ID number and Maximum capacity available for the new
logical drive are displayed.
4.
5.
6.
Highlight the following parameters and press the backspace key to erase the
current value:
•
Alias - Type an alias into the field, if desired. Maximum of 32 characters.
Use letters, numbers, space between words and underscore.
•
Capacity - Maximum capacity shown. Enter a smaller capacity if
desired.
Highlight the following parameters and press the spacebar to toggle though
the available choices:
•
Stripe size – Press the spacebar to select: 64 KB, 128 KB, 256 KB,
512 KB, or 1 MB
•
Sector size – Press the spacebar to select: 512 B; 1 KB, 2 KB, or 4 KB
•
Write Policy – Press spacebar to select: Write Back or Write Through
•
Read Policy – Press spacebar to select: No Cache, Read Cache, or
Read Ahead Cache
Highlight Preferred Controller ID and press the spacebar to toggle among 1,
2, or Automatic. Applies to dual-controller capable Fibre Channel models
only.
174
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
7.
Highlight Number of Axles and press the spacebar to select the number of
axles. Applies to RAID 50 and 60 only.
8.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
Note
If you did not use all of the available capacity of the disk array, you
can create an additional logical drive at this point.
Deleting a Logical Drive
Caution
When you delete a logical drive, you delete all the data it contains.
Back up all important data before deleting a logical drive.
To delete a logical drive from a disk array:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Disk Array Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the disk array that contains the logical drive you want to delete and
press Enter.
3.
Highlight the logical drive you want to delete and press the spacebar to mark
it.
The mark is an asterisk (*) to the left of the listing.
4.
Highlight Delete Marked Logical Drives and press Enter.
5.
Press Y to confirm the deletion.
175
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Managing Logical Drives
The Logical Drive Management function deals with settings and functions of
existing logical drives. To create or delete a logical drive, see “Managing Disk
Arrays” on page 165. Logical drive management includes:
•
Viewing Logical Drive Information (page 176)
•
Setting an Alias for a Logical Drive (page 176)
•
Setting Write Cache Policy (page 176)
•
Setting Read Cache Policy (page 177)
•
Setting Preferred Controller ID (page 177)
•
Initializing a Logical Drive (page 177)
•
Running Redundancy Check (page 178)
•
Locating a Logical Drive (page 178)
Viewing Logical Drive Information
To view logical drive information:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Logical Drive Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the logical drive you want and press Enter.
The information and settings screen appears.
3.
Highlight any of the following and press Enter to view more information:
•
Check Table – Read Check, Write Check, and Inconsistency Check
Tables
•
Logical Drive Statistics
Setting an Alias for a Logical Drive
To set an alias for a logical drive:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Logical Drive Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the logical drive you want and press Enter.
3.
To set an alias for this disk array, highlight Alias and type an alias into the
field.
Maximum of 32 characters. Use letters, numbers, space between words and
underscore. An alias is optional.
4.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
Setting Write Cache Policy
To set write cache policy on a logical drive:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Logical Drive Management and press Enter.
176
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
2.
Highlight the logical drive you want and press Enter.
3.
To set write cache policy for this logical drive, highlight WritePolicy and press
the spacebar to toggle between WriteBack and WriteThru (write though).
4.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
Setting Read Cache Policy
To set read cache policy on a logical drive:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Logical Drive Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the logical drive you want and press Enter.
3.
To set read cache policy for this logical drive, highlight ReadPolicy and press
the spacebar to toggle though ReadCache, ReadAhead and None.
4.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
Setting Preferred Controller ID
This feature applies to dual-controller capable Fibre Channel models only.
To set the preferred controller for this logical drive:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Logical Drive Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the logical drive you want and press Enter.
3.
To set the preferred controller ID for this logical drive, highlight Preferred
Controller ID and press the spacebar to toggle between 1 and 2.
4.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
Initializing a Logical Drive
This function sets all data bits in the logical drive to zero.
Caution
When you initialize a logical drive, you delete all the data it
contains. Back up all important data before initializing a logical
drive.
To initialize a logical drive:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Logical Drive Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the logical drive you want and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Background Activity and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Start Initialization and press Enter.
The initialization parameters appear.
•
Initialization pattern. The default 00000000 is best for most applications
177
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
•
Quick Initialization – Yes means only the first and last sections of the
logical drives are initialized. No means the entire logical drive is
initialized.
•
Quick Initialization Size – Enter a value for the first and last sections of
the logical drive to be initialized or use the default 64 MB.
To change a parameter, highlight it and press the backspace key to erase
the current value, then type the new value.
5.
Highlight Start and press Enter.
If necessary, you can pause and resume or stop and restart the Initialization.
You cannot access the logical drive until Initialization has finished.
Running Redundancy Check
Redundancy Check is a maintenance procedure for logical drives in fault-tolerant
disk arrays that ensures all the data matches exactly. To run Redundancy Check:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Logical Drive Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the logical drive you want and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Background Activity and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Start Redundancy Check and press Enter.
The redundancy check parameters appear.
•
Auto Fix – Corrects inconsistencies automatically
•
Pause On Error – Pauses the Redundancy Check when an error is
found
To change a parameter, highlight it and press the backspace toggle between
Yes and No.
5.
Highlight Start and press Enter.
If necessary, you can pause and resume or stop and restart the Redundancy
Check. You can use the logical drive while Redundancy Check is running.
Locating a Logical Drive
This feature helps you identify the physical drives assigned to the logical drive
you are working with in the CLU. To locate a logical drive:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Logical Drive Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the disk array you want and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Locate Logical Drive and press Enter.
The drive status LEDs for the physical drives in this logical drive will blink for
one minute.
178
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
Managing the Network Connection
Network Management deals with network connections and settings for the
Management Ports. Each Management Port can be configured:
•
Making Subsystem Management Port Settings (page 179)
•
Making Controller Maintenance Mode Settings (page 179)
Making Subsystem Management Port Settings
The VTrak subsystem has a virtual management port. When you log into the
VTrak over your network, you use the virtual management port.
Before you change settings, please see “Choosing DHCP or a Static IP Address”
on page 36.
Making Automatic Settings
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Network Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the Virtual management port and press Enter.
3.
Highlight NetMgmt Ethernet Port Settings and press Enter
4.
Highlight DHCP and press the spacebar to toggle to Enabled.
5.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
Making Manual Settings
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Network Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight the Virtual management port and press Enter.
3.
Highlight NetMgmt Ethernet Port Settings and press Enter
4.
Highlight DHCP and press the spacebar to toggle to Disabled.
5.
Highlight each of the following and press the backspace key to erase the
current value, then type the new value.
6.
•
IP Address
•
Subnet Mask
•
Default Gateway IP Address
•
DNS Server IP Address
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
Making Controller Maintenance Mode Settings
Each RAID controller has an IP addresses for access when the controller goes
into maintenance mode. Maintenance mode is only for remedial action in the
event of a problem with the controller. See “Controller Enters Maintenance Mode”
on page 298 for more information.
179
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Before you change settings, please see “Choosing DHCP or a Static IP Address”
on page 36.
Making Automatic Settings
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Network Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Maintenance Mode Network Configuration and press Enter.
3.
Highlight the controller you want and press Enter.
4.
Highlight DHCP and press the spacebar to toggle to Enabled.
5.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
Making Manual Settings
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Network Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Maintenance Mode Network Configuration and press Enter.
3.
Highlight the controller you want and press Enter.
4.
Highlight DHCP and press the spacebar to toggle to Disabled.
5.
Highlight each of the following and press the backspace key to erase the
current value, then type the new value.
6.
•
IP Address
•
Subnet Mask
•
Default Gateway IP Address
•
DNS Server IP Address
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
180
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
Managing Fibre Channel Connections
The Fibre Channel Management option appears only with VTrak Fibre Channel
models. Fibre Channel Management includes the following functions:
•
Viewing Node Information (page 181)
•
Viewing Fibre Channel Logged-in Devices (page 181)
•
Making Fibre Channel Port Settings (page 181)
•
Viewing SFP Information (page 182)
•
Viewing Fibre Channel Port Statistics (page 182)
•
Viewing Fibre Channel Initiators (page 183)
•
Adding a Fibre Channel Initiator (page 183)
Viewing Node Information
These functions affect both VTrak Fibre Channel ports.
1.
2.
From the Main Menu, highlight Fibre Channel Management and press Enter.
Highlight Fibre Channel Node and press Enter.
Node information appears. There are no user settings on this screen.
Viewing Fibre Channel Logged-in Devices
To view a list of logged-in devices:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Fibre Channel Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Fibre Channel Ports and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Fibre Channel Port 1 or Port 2 and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Logged In Devices and press Enter.
If a Fibre Channel switch is attached, it will also appear in this list.
Making Fibre Channel Port Settings
To make Fibre Channel port settings:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Fibre Channel Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Fibre Channel Ports and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Fibre Channel Port 1 or Port 2 and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Fibre Channel Port Settings and press Enter.
5.
Highlight the following parameters and press the spacebar to toggle though
the choices:
•
Configured Link Speed – 1 Gb/s, 2 Gb/s, 4 Gb/s, or Automatic selection
•
Configured Topology – NL-Port (Arbitrated Loop), N-Port (Point to
Point) or Automatic selection
181
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
6.
Highlight Hard ALPA and press the backspace key to erase the current
value, then type the new value.
The range is 0 to 255. 255 disables this feature.
7.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
The table below shows the type of attached topology you will achieve based on
your connection type and the configured topology you select:
Fibre Channel Attached Topology
Configured Topology
Connection Type
N-Port
NL-Port
Switch
Fabric Direct
Public Loop
Direct
Point to Point
Private Loop
Example 1: If you connect the VTrak to a Fibre Channel switch and select NLPort topology, you will create a Public Loop attached topology.
Example 2: If you have a Point to Point attached topology, you made a direct
connection (no switch) and selected N-port topology.
Note
In some cases, HBA settings to N-Port only work if connected to
the switch. Refer to your HBA manual for more information.
Viewing SFP Information
To view information about the SFPs (small form-factor plugable transceivers):
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Fibre Channel Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Fibre Channel Ports and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Fibre Channel Port 1 or Port 2 and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Fibre Channel Port SFP and press Enter.
The screen displays information about the SFP transceiver. There are no
user settings on this screen.
Viewing Fibre Channel Port Statistics
To view port statistics:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Fibre Channel Management and press Enter.
182
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
2.
Highlight Fibre Channel Ports and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Fibre Channel Port 1 or Port 2 and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Fibre Channel Port Statistics and press Enter.
This screen displays statistics for this port. There are no user settings on this
screen.
Viewing Fibre Channel Initiators
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Fibre Channel Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Fibre Channel Initiators and press Enter.
A list of initiators appears.
To create an initiator, see “Creating an Initiator” on page 193.
Adding a Fibre Channel Initiator
You must add an initiator to the VTrak’s initiator list in order to use the initiator to
create a LUN for your logical drive.
To add an initiator:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Fibre Channel Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Fibre Channel Initiators and press Enter.
3.
Highlight the initiator you want to add and press the spacebar to select it.
4.
Highlight Add Marked Initiators and press Enter.
The initiator is added to VTrak’s initiator list.
183
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Managing SAS Connections
The SAS Management option appears only with VTrak Serial Attached SCSI
models. SAS Management includes the following functions:
•
Viewing SAS Port Information (page 184)
•
Making SAS Port Settings (page 184)
•
Viewing SAS Port Statistics (page 185)
•
Viewing SAS Initiators (page 185)
•
Adding a SAS Initiator (page 185)
Viewing SAS Port Information
There are two SAS ports on each controller. To view information about the SAS
ports:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight SAS Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight SAS Ports and press Enter.
3.
Highlight the port you want to see and press Enter.
The port information appears on the screen.
Adjustable Items
•
Cable Signal Strength
See “Making SAS Port Settings” on page 184.
Making SAS Port Settings
There are two SAS ports on each controller. To make settings to the SAS ports:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight SAS Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight SAS Ports and press Enter.
3.
Highlight the port you want to see and press Enter.
4.
Highlight SAS Port Settings and press Enter.
5.
Highlight Cable Signal Strength, press the backspace key to erase the
current value, then type in the new value.
The range is 1 to 8. 1 is the default. Signal strength correlates to cable length
in meters. Example: If you have a 2 m SAS cable, set signal strength to 2. If
performance is unsatisfactory (see “Viewing SAS Port Statistics” on
page 185), try settings of 1 and 3, then use the best setting for your system.
6.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
184
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
Viewing SAS Port Statistics
There are two SAS ports on each controller. To view information about the SAS
ports:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight SAS Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight SAS Ports and press Enter.
3.
Highlight the port you want to see and press Enter.
4.
Highlight SAS Port Statistics and press Enter.
The statistics for the selected port appear on the screen.
Viewing SAS Initiators
There are two SAS ports on each controller, for a total of four SAS ports. To a
view a list of initiators currently logged any of the four SAS ports:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight SAS Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight SAS Initiators and press Enter.
A list of all currently logged-in initiators appears on the screen.
Adding a SAS Initiator
You must add an initiator to the VTrak’s initiator list in order to use the initiator to
create a LUN for your logical drive.
To add an initiator:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight SAS Management and press Enter.
2.
Highlight SAS Initiators and press Enter.
3.
Highlight the initiator you want to add and press the spacebar to select it.
4.
Highlight Add Marked Initiators and press Enter.
The initiator is added to VTrak’s initiator list.
185
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Managing Background Activity
Background activity refers to any of several functions that take place in the
background while normal operation of the VTrak continues.
Background activities work in conjunction with disk arrays and logical drives. See
“Managing Disk Arrays” on page 165 and “Managing Logical Drives” on page 176
for more information about how and when to use background activities.
Background Activity Management includes the following functions:
•
Viewing Current Background Activities (page 186)
•
Making Background Activity Settings (page 186)
Viewing Current Background Activities
From the Main Menu, highlight Background Activity and press Enter. A count of
current background activities appears, including:
•
Rebuild
•
PDM – Predictive Data Migration
•
Synchronization
•
Redundancy Check
•
Migration
•
Transition
•
Initialization
•
Media Patrol
Making Background Activity Settings
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Background Activity and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Background Activity Settings and press Enter.
3.
Highlight following and press the spacebar to toggle between Enabled and
Disabled.
4.
•
Media Patrol – Checks the magnetic media on physical drives
•
Auto Rebuild – If there is a spare drive of adequate capacity, a critical
disk array will begin to rebuild automatically. If not spare drive is
available, the disk array will begin to rebuild as soon as you replace the
failed physical drive with an unconfigured physical drive of equal or
greater size.
Highlight following and press the spacebar to toggle through Low, Medium,
and High rates:
•
Rebuild – Checks the data integrity on disk arrays
•
Migration – Change RAID level or add physical dries to disk arrays
186
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
•
PDM – Looks for bad blocks on the physical drives of disk arrays
•
Transition – Returns a revertible spare drive to spare status
•
Synchronization – Checks the data integrity on disk arrays
•
Initialization – Sets all data bits in the logical drive to zero
•
Redundancy Check – Checks, reports and can correct data
inconsistencies in logical drives
The rates are defined as follows:
5.
6.
•
Low – Fewer resources to activity, more to data read/write.
•
Medium – Balance of resources to activity and data read/write.
•
High – More resources to activity, fewer to data read/write.
Highlight the following PDM trigger settings and press the backspace key to
erase the current value:
•
Reassigned Block Threshold – 1 to 512 blocks
•
Error Block Threshold – 1 to 1024 blocks
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
187
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Working with the Event Viewer
The Event Viewer displays log of subsystem events. Events are classified as:
•
Runtime Events – A list of and information about the 1023 most recent
runtime events recorded since the subsystem was started
•
NVRAM Events – A list of and information about most important events over
multiple subsystem startups. NVRAM events are stored in non-volatile
memory
Working with the Event Viewer includes the following functions:
•
Viewing Runtime Events (page 188)
•
Clearing Runtime Events (page 188)
•
Viewing NVRAM Events (page 188)
•
Clearing NVRAM Events (page 189)
Viewing Runtime Events
To display Runtime Events:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Event Viewer and press Enter.
The log of Runtime Events appears. Events are added to the top of the list.
Each item includes:
2.
•
Sequence number – Begins with 0 at system startup.
•
Device – Disk Array, Logical Drive, Physical Drive by its ID number.
•
Severity – (lowest to highest) Information, Warning, Minor, Major,
Critical and Fatal
•
Timestamp – Date and time the event happened.
•
Description – A description of the event in plain language.
Press the up and down arrow keys to scroll through the log.
Clearing Runtime Events
To clear the Runtime Event log:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Event Viewer and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Clear Runtime Event Log and press Enter.
3.
Press Y to confirm.
Viewing NVRAM Events
This screen displays a list of and information about 63 most important events
over multiple subsystem startups.
To display NVRAM events:
188
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
1.
2.
From the Main Menu, highlight Event Viewer and press Enter.
Highlight NVRAM Events and press Enter.
The log of NVRAM Events appears. Events are added to the top of the list.
Each item includes:
3.
•
Sequence number – Begins with 0 at system startup.
•
Device – Disk Array, Logical Drive, Physical Drive by its ID number.
•
Severity – (lowest to highest) Information, Warning, Minor, Major,
Critical and Fatal
•
Timestamp – Date and time the event happened.
•
Description – A description of the event in plain language.
Press the up and down arrow keys to scroll through the log.
Clearing NVRAM Events
To clear the Runtime Event log:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Event Viewer and press Enter.
2.
Highlight NVRAM Events and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Clear NVRAM Event Log and press Enter.
4.
Press Y to confirm.
189
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Managing Spare Drives
Spare Drive Management includes the following functions:
•
Viewing a list of Spare Drives (page 190)
•
Creating a Spare Drive (page 190)
•
Making Spare Drive Settings (page 191)
•
Running Spare Check (page 191)
•
Deleting a Spare Drive (page 192)
Viewing a list of Spare Drives
To view a list of spare drives:
1.
2.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
Highlight Spare Drive Management and press Enter.
A list of the current spare drives appears, including the following parameters:
•
ID number
•
Operational Status
•
Physical Drive ID number
•
Configured Capacity
•
Revertible – The spare drive returns to spare status after you replace
the failed drive in the disk array. See “Transition” on page 257 for more
information.
•
Type – Global (all disk arrays) or Dedicated (to specified disk arrays)
•
Dedicated to Array – The array to which a dedicated spare is assigned
Creating a Spare Drive
Only unconfigured physical drives can be used to make spares. Check your
available drives under Physical Drive Management. See “Managing Physical
Drives” on page 162.
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight Spare Drive Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Create New Spare Drive and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Physical Drive Number and press the backspace key to erase the
current value, then type the new value.
Specify the number of the physical drive you want for your spare. The
available drive numbers are in parentheses.
5.
Highlight Revertible and press the spacebar to toggle between Yes and No.
190
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
A revertible drive can be returned to spare status after you replace the failed
drive in a disk array. See “Transition” on page 257 for more information.
6.
Highlight Spare Type and press the spacebar to toggle between Dedicated
and Global.
Dedicated means this spare drive can only be used with the specified disk
arrays. Global means this spare drive can be used by any disk array.
7.
If you chose Dedicated, highlight Dedicated to Arrays and press the
backspace key to erase the current value, then type the new value.
Specify the number(s) of the disk array(s) you want to assign your spare.
The current disk arrays are listed in parentheses.
8.
Press Ctrl-A to save the spare drive.
Making Spare Drive Settings
To change spare drive settings:
1.
2.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
Highlight Spare Drive Management and press Enter.
A list of the current spare drives appears, including the following parameters:
3.
Highlight the spare drive you want to change and press Enter.
4.
Highlight the setting you want to change:
•
Revertible – A revertible drive can be returned to spare status after you
replace the failed drive in a disk array. See “Transition” on page 257 for
more information.
•
Type – Dedicated means this spare drive can only be used with the
specified disk array(s). Global means this spare drive can be used by
any disk array.
5.
Press the spacebar to toggle between the choices.
6.
For dedicated spares, type the array number the spare is assigned to.
7.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
Running Spare Check
To run Spare Check:
1.
2.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
Highlight Spare Drive Management and press Enter.
A list of the current spare drives appears.
3.
Highlight the spare drive you want to check and press Enter.
191
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
4.
Highlight Start Spare Check and press Enter.
The results appear next to Spare Check Status.
Deleting a Spare Drive
Caution
If the spare drive you delete is the only spare, the controller will
not rebuild a critical array until you provide a new spare drive.
1.
Highlight the spare drive you want to delete and press the spacebar to mark
it.
The mark is an asterisk (*) to the left of the listing.
2.
Highlight Delete Marked Spare Drives and press Enter.
3.
Press Y to confirm the deletion.
192
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
Working with LUN Mapping
LUN Mapping includes the following functions:
•
Viewing a List of Initiators (page 193)
•
Enabling LUN Mapping (page 193)
•
Creating an Initiator (page 193)
•
Mapping a LUN to an Initiator (page 194)
•
Deleting an Initiator (page 194)
Viewing a List of Initiators
LUN Mapping must be enabled in order for VTrak to recognize a Fibre Channel
or SAS initiator. To view a list of initiators:
1.
2.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
Highlight LUN Mapping and press Enter.
A list of the current initiators appears.
Enabling LUN Mapping
To enable LUN mapping:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight LUN Mapping and press Enter.
A list of the current Fibre Channel or SAS initiators appears.
LUN Mapping must be enabled in order for VTrak to recognize the initiator. If
LUN Mapping is currently disabled, highlight Enable LUN Mapping and press
Enter.
Creating an Initiator
You must add an initiator to the VTrak’s initiator list in order to use the initiator to
create a LUN. You can also add initiators under Fibre Channel Management see
page 183 or SAS Management, see page 185.
To create (add) a new initiator:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight LUN Mapping and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Create New Initiator and press Enter.
4.
Type the name of the initiator.
193
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
•
Fibre Channel – A Fibre Channel initiator name is the World Wide Port
Name of the device and is composed of a series of eight, two-digit
hexadecimal numbers.
•
SAS – A SAS initiator name is the SAS address of the HBA card in the
Host PC. Obtain the initiator name from the initiator utility on your host
system.
Obtain the initiator name from the initiator utility on your host system.
Note that the initiator name you input must match exactly in order for the
connection to work.
5.
Press Ctrl-A to save the initiator.
Note
LUN Mapping must be enabled in order for VTrak to recognize the
initiator.
Mapping a LUN to an Initiator
You must add an initiator to the VTrak’s initiator list in order to use the initiator to
create a LUN. You can add initiators under Fibre Channel Management see
page 183, under SAS Management, see page 185, or under “Creating an
Initiator” on page 193.
To map a LUN to an initiator:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight LUN Mapping and press Enter.
3.
Highlight an existing Initiator and press Enter.
A list of logical drives displays.
4.
In the LUN field, press the backspace key to erase the current value, then
type the LUN you want to assign to this initiator, from 0 to 255.
If you make a error, press Ctrl-R to restore the current LUN.
5.
Press Ctrl-A to save the LUN map.
Deleting an Initiator
To delete an initiator:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight LUN Mapping and press Enter.
3.
Highlight the initiator you want to delete and press the spacebar to mark it.
194
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
The mark is an asterisk (*) to the left of the listing.
4.
Highlight Delete Marked Initiators and press Enter.
5.
Press Y to confirm the deletion.
195
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Managing Users
User Management includes the following functions:
•
Viewing User Information (page 196)
•
Creating a User (page 196)
•
Changing a User’s Password (page 197)
•
Changing a User’s Display Name and Email Address (page 197)
•
Changing a User’s Privilege and Status (page 198)
•
Deleting a User (page 198)
Viewing User Information
Each user types their user name and password to log into the CLI.
To view a list of current user accounts:
1.
2.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
Highlight User Management and press Enter.
A list of the current users appears.
Creating a User
To create a new user account:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight User Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Create New User and press Enter.
4.
Highlight each field and type in the appropriate information:
5.
•
User name (no spaces)
•
Password (Optional. Maximum 32 characters. Use letters, numbers,
space between words and underscore)
•
Display name (Optional)
Highlight Privilege and press the space bar to toggle though the options:
For definitions of each privilege level, see the List of User Privileges below.
6.
7.
Highlight Status and press the space bar to toggle between the options:
•
Enabled – Allows the user to log in to the system
•
Disabled – Prevents the user from logging in to the system
Press Ctrl-A to save the user.
196
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
List of User Privileges
•
View – Allows the user to see all status and settings but not to make any
changes
•
Maintenance – Allows the user to perform maintenance tasks including
Rebuilding, PDM, Media Patrol, and Redundancy Check
•
Power – Allows the user to create (but not delete) disk arrays and logical
drives, change RAID levels, change stripe size; change settings of
components such as disk arrays, logical drives, physical drives, and the
controller.
•
Super – Allows the user full access to all functions including create and
delete users and changing the settings of other users, and delete disk arrays
and logical drives. The default “administrator” account is a Super User.
Changing a User’s Password
Each user can change their own password. A Super user can change other
user’s passwords. To change a user’s password:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight User Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight a User in the list and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Change Password... and press Enter.
5.
Highlight New Password and type the password.
6.
Highlight Retype Password and type the password again to verify.
7.
Press Ctrl-A to save the password.
Changing a User’s Display Name and Email Address
Each user can change their display name and email address. To change a
display name or email address:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight User Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight a User in the list and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Display Name and press Enter.
5.
Highlight the items you want and press the backspace key to erase the
current value, then type the new value:
6.
•
User name
•
Email address
Press Ctrl-A to save the settings.
197
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Changing a User’s Privilege and Status
No user can change their own privilege or status. To change another user’s
privilege or status.
1.
Log in as the Administrator or a Super user.
2.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
3.
Highlight User Management and press Enter.
4.
Highlight a User in the list and press Enter.
5.
Highlight Display Name and press Enter.
6.
Highlight Privilege and press the space bar to toggle though the options:
For definitions of each privilege level, see “List of User Privileges” on
page 197.
7.
8.
Highlight Status and press the space bar to toggle between the options:
•
Enabled – Allows the user to log in to the system
•
Disabled – Prevents the user from logging in to the system
Press Ctrl-A to save the settings.
Deleting a User
To delete a user:
1.
Log in under a user name other than the one you want to delete.
2.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
3.
Highlight User Management and press Enter.
4.
Highlight the user you want to delete and press the spacebar to mark it.
The mark is an asterisk (*) to the left of the listing.
5.
Highlight Delete Marked Users and press Enter.
6.
Press Y to confirm the deletion.
198
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
Working with Software Management
Software Management includes the following functions:
•
Making Email Settings (page 199)
•
Making SLP Settings (page 200)
•
Making Webserver Settings (page 200)
•
Making Telnet Settings (page 201)
•
Making SNMP Settings (page 201)
•
Managing SNMP Trap Sinks (page 202)
•
Making CIM Settings (page 203)
•
Making Netsend Settings (page 203)
•
Managing Netsend Recipients (page 204)
Making Email Settings
By default, Email service is set to Automatic and its normal status is Started.
To make Email service settings:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight Software Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Email and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Startup Type and press the spacebar to toggle between Automatic
and Manual.
5.
Highlight the following and press the backspace key to erase the current
value, then type the new value:
6.
•
Server IP address
•
Server Port number – 25 is the default
Highlight Authentication and press the spacebar to toggle between Yes and
No.
If you selected Yes, type in a User name and Password in the fields
provided.
7.
8.
The following items are optional but recommended. Highlight and press the
backspace key to erase the current value, then type the new value:
•
Sender’s email address
•
Subject Line for the email message
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
To start, stop or restart the Email service, highlight Start, Stop or Restart and
press Enter.
199
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Making SLP Settings
By default, SLP service is set to Automatic and its normal status is Started.
To make SLP service settings:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight Software Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight SLP and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Startup Type and press the spacebar to toggle between Automatic
and Manual.
5.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
To start, stop or restart the SLP service, highlight Start, Stop, or Restart and
press Enter.
Making Webserver Settings
By default, Webserver service is set to Automatic and its normal status is Started.
To make Webserver service settings:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight Software Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Webserver and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Startup Type and press the spacebar to toggle between Automatic
and Manual.
5.
Highlight the following and press the backspace key to erase the current
value, then type the new value:
•
HTTP Port – 80 is the default
•
Session Time Out – 24 minutes is the default. 1440 minutes = 24 hours
6.
Highlight SSL and press the spacebar to toggle between Enabled and
Disabled.
7.
Highlight HTTPS Port and press the backspace key to erase the current
value, then type the new value. 443 is the default.
8.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
To start, stop or restart the Webserver service, highlight Start, Stop, or Restart
and press Enter.
200
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
Making Telnet Settings
By default, Telnet service is set to Automatic and its normal status is Started. To
make Telnet service settings:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight Software Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Telnet and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Startup Type and press the spacebar to toggle between Automatic
and Manual.
5.
Highlight the following and press the backspace key to erase the current
value, then type the new value:
6.
•
Port number – 2300 is the default
•
Session Time Out – 24 minutes is the default. 1440 minutes = 24 hours
•
Maximum number of connections – 4 is the default
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
To start, stop or restart the Telnet service, highlight Start, Stop, or Restart and
press Enter.
Making SNMP Settings
By default, SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol) service is set to
Automatic and its normal status is Started.
To make SNMP service settings:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight Software Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight SNMP and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Startup Type and press the spacebar to toggle between Automatic
and Manual.
5.
Highlight the following and press the backspace key to erase the current
value, then type the new value:
•
Port Number – 161 is the default
•
System Name – (optional) Type a system name in this field
•
System Location – Type a country name in this field
•
System Contact – Type the email address of your system administrator
in this field
•
Read Community – Type a community name in this field
•
Write Community – private (no change possible)
201
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
6.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
To start, stop or restart the SNMP service, highlight Start, Stop, or Restart and
press Enter.
Managing SNMP Trap Sinks
Creating a SNMP trap sink
To create a trap sink:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight Software Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight SNMP and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Trap Sinks and press Enter.
A list of the current trap sinks appears.
Adding a trap sink
To add a trap sink:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight Software Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Create New Trap Sink and press Enter
4.
Highlight Trap Sink IP address and press the backspace key to erase the
current value, then type the new IP address in this field.
5.
Highlight Trap Filter and press the spacebar to toggle through the severity
levels.
The Severity Levels are (lowest to highest) Information, Warning, Minor,
Major, Critical and Fatal.
6.
Press Ctrl-A to save the Trap Sink.
Deleting a trap sink
To delete a trap sink:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight Software Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight the trap sink you want to delete and press the spacebar to mark it.
The mark is an asterisk (*) to the left of the listing.
4.
Highlight Delete Marked Entries and press Enter.
202
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
Making CIM Settings
By default, CIM (Common Information Model [a protocol]) service is set to
Automatic and its normal status is Started.
To make CIM service settings:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight Software Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight CIM and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Startup Type and press the spacebar to toggle between Automatic
and Manual.
5.
Highlight HTTP and press the spacebar to toggle between Enabled and
Disabled.
6.
Highlight HTTP Port, press the backspace key to erase, type new value.
5988 is the default port number.
7.
Highlight HTTPS and press the spacebar to toggle between Enabled and
Disabled.
8.
Highlight HTTPS Port, press the backspace key to erase, type new value.
5989 is the default port number.
9.
Highlight Authentication and press the spacebar to toggle between Enabled
and Disabled.
Note: There is only one user. The default name is cim. No changes are
possible.
Note: CIM service must be running to change the password.
The default password is password.
10. Highlight Change Password... and press Enter to change the password.
11. Highlight Old Password and type the current password.
12. Highlight New Password and type a new password.
13. Highlight Retype Password and type the new password again.
14. Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
To start, stop or restart the CIM service, highlight Start, Stop, or Restart and
press Enter.
Making Netsend Settings
By default, Netsend service is set to Manual and its normal status is Stopped.
To make Netsend service settings:
203
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight Software Management and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Netsend and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Startup Type and press the spacebar to toggle between Automatic
and Manual.
5.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
To start, stop or restart the Netsend service, highlight Start, Stop, or Restart and
press Enter.
Managing Netsend Recipients
Note that the Messenger service must be running on the recipient PC in order to
receive reports.
Adding a recipient
To add a recipient:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight Software Management and press Enter.
1.
Highlight Netsend and press Enter.
2.
Highlight Message Recipient and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Create New Message Recipient and press Enter.
4.
Type the recipient’s IP address into the field provided.
5.
Highlight Message Event Severity Filter and press the spacebar to change
severity levels.
The selected level and all higher severity levels of severity will be reported.
Severity levels (from lowest to highest) are: Info, Warning, Minor, Major,
Critical, and Fatal.
6.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
Changing Recipient Settings
To change recipient settings:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight Software Management and press Enter.
1.
Highlight the recipient whose settings you want to change and press Enter.
2.
Type the recipient’s IP address into the field provided.
204
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
3.
Highlight Message Event Severity Filter and press the spacebar to change
severity levels.
4.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
Deleting a Recipient
To delete a recipient:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight Software Management and press Enter.
1.
Highlight the recipient you want to delete and press the spacebar to mark it.
The mark is an asterisk (*) to the left of the listing
2.
Highlight Delete Marked Entries and press Enter.
NetSend Requirements
In order to use NetSend:
•
NetSend must be running the VTrak
•
You must provide the IP address for each recipient PC
•
The Messenger service must be running on each recipient PC
If your NetSend and Messenger service settings are correct but the recipient PC
does not receive event messages, check the recipient PC’s Firewall settings.
Refer to your OS documentation for more information.
205
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Flashing through TFTP
Use this function to flash the VTrak’s firmware. See “Updating the Firmware in
the CLU” on page 216 for this procedure.
206
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
Clearing Statistics
This function clears the statistical counts for the RAID controller, Fibre Channel
ports, SAS ports, physical drives, and logical drives. To clear statistics:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight Clear Statistics and press Enter.
3.
Press Y to confirm the deletion.
207
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Restoring Factory Defaults
This function restores the factory default settings to the firmware and software
items you select.
Caution
Use this function with care. Do not restore to default settings for
any item unless you are sure this action is needed.
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight Restore Factory Defaults and press Enter.
3.
Highlight the setting group you want and press the spacebar to toggle
between Yes and No.
Yes means this setting will be restored to the default value.
4.
Highlight Restore Factory Defaults and press Enter.
5.
Press Y to confirm the reset.
208
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
Shutting Down the Subsystem
There are two methods for shutting down the subsystem. Choose one of the
following procedures:
•
Shutting down the VTrak – Telnet Connection (page 209)
•
Shutting down the VTrak – Serial Connection (page 209)
Shutting down the VTrak – Telnet Connection
This function enables you to shutdown the VTrak subsystem on a Telnet
connection. You can only do part of this procedure in the CLU. Additional action
is required, as described below. To shutdown the VTrak:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight Shutdown or Restart and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Shutdown or Restart and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Option and press the spacebar to display Restart.
5.
Highlight Submit and press Enter.
A warning message appears.
6.
Press Y to continue.
The screen will go blank.
7.
Wait for no less than two minutes.
8.
Manually turn off the power supply switches on the back of the subsystem.
Shutting down the VTrak – Serial Connection
This function enables you to shutdown the VTrak subsystem on a serial
connection. You can only do part of this procedure in the CLU. Additional action
is required, as described below. To shutdown the VTrak:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight Shutdown or Restart and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Shutdown or Restart and press Enter.
4.
Highlight Option and press the spacebar to display Restart.
5.
Highlight Submit and press Enter.
A warning message appears.
6.
Press Y to continue.
7.
Turn off the power supply switches when you see the following message:
209
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Shutdown complete. It is now safe to power off
the subsystem.
210
Chapter 5: Management with the CLU
Restarting the Subsystem
There are two methods for restarting the subsystem. Choose one of the following
procedures:
•
Restarting the Subsystem (page 211)
•
Restarting VTrak – Serial Connection (page 211)
Restarting VTrak – Telnet Connection
This function enables you to restart the VTrak subsystem on a Telnet connection.
You can only do part of this procedure in the CLU. Additional action is required,
as described below. To restart the VTrak:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight Shutdown or Restart and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Option and press the spacebar to display Restart.
4.
Highlight Submit and press Enter.
A warning message appears.
5.
Press Y to continue.
The screen will go blank.
6.
Wait for no less than two minutes.
7.
Re-establish your Telnet connection to the VTrak CLU.
If you cannot re-establish a connection, wait 30 seconds, then try again.
Restarting VTrak – Serial Connection
This function enables you to restart the VTrak subsystem on a serial connection.
You can only do part of this procedure in the CLU. Additional action is required,
as described below. To restart the VTrak:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight Shutdown or Restart and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Option and press the spacebar to display Restart.
4.
Highlight Submit and press Enter.
A warning message appears.
5.
Press Y to continue.
6.
When the Login: prompt appears, log into the CLU again.
The screen will display shutdown and startup functions.
211
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Making Buzzer Settings
This function enables the buzzer on the controller. When you first power-up the
VTrak, it beeps twice to show normal operation. To change buzzer settings:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Buzzer and press Enter.
A list of Controllers appears with the current buzzer setting and status.
2.
Highlight the Controller whose buzzer you want to set and press Enter.
3.
Highlight Enabled and press the spacebar to toggle between Yes and No.
4.
Press Ctrl-A to save your settings.
The buzzer provides the audible alarm. See “VTrak is Beeping” on page 262.
212
Chapter 6: Maintenance
This chapter covers the following topics:
•
Updating the Firmware in WebPAM PROe (page 213)
•
Updating the Firmware in the CLU (page 216)
•
Replacing a Power Supply (page 218)
•
Replacing a Cooling Unit Fan or Blower (page 219)
•
Replacing a Cache Battery (page 224)
•
Replacing a RAID Controller (page 228)
Updating the Firmware in WebPAM PROe
A firmware update consists of the following actions:
•
Downloading the Firmware Image File (page 213)
•
Updating Firmware from TFTP Server (page 213) or
Updating Firmware from your PC (page 214)
•
Restarting the Subsystem (page 215)
Downloading the Firmware Image File
Go to the Promise website at http://www.promise.com/support and download the
latest firmware image (.img) file to your TFTP server or your PC. The firmware
update image file includes all of the files for the VTrak, including:
•
Firmware
•
Software
•
Kernel
•
RedBoot
•
Other files
Updating Firmware from TFTP Server
To update the firmware from a TFTP server:
1.
Click the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click on the Software Management
icon.
4.
Click on the Firmware Update tab.
5.
Do one of the following actions:
•
icon.
Click on the Download from TFTP Server option, then click on the Next
button.
213
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
•
From the Firmware Update tab dropdown menu, select Download from
TFTP Server.
6.
Enter the hostname or IP address of your TFTP server in the field provided.
7.
Enter the port number of your TFTP server in the field provided (69 is the
default).
8.
Enter the filename of the Firmware Update file in the field provided.
9.
Click the Submit button.
10. When the download is completed, click the Next button.
A popup message appears warning you not to reboot the VTrak during the
firmware update procedure.
11. In the popup message, click the OK button.
The update progress displays. Then a popup message appears to tell you to
reboot the VTrak.
12. In the popup message, click the OK button.
13. Restart the VTrak. See “Restarting the Subsystem” on page 215.
Note
After you click the Submit button, if WebPAM PROe displays this
message: error transferring image, you entered an incorrect file
name or an incorrect location. Check the information and try
again.
Updating Firmware from your PC
To update the firmware from your PC:
1.
Click the Subsystem
2.
Click the Administrative Tools
3.
Click on the Software Management
4.
Click on the Firmware Update tab.
5.
Do one of the following actions:
6.
icon in Tree View.
icon.
icon.
•
Click on the Download Flash File from Local File through HTTP option,
then click on the Next button.
•
From the Firmware Update tab dropdown menu, select Download from
Local File.
Enter the filename of the Firmware Update file in the field provided.
Or, click the Browse... button and select the Firmware Update file in the
Open dialog box.
7.
Click the Submit button.
214
Chapter 6: Maintenance
8.
When the download is completed, click the Next button.
A popup message appears to warn you not to reboot the VTrak during the
firmware update procedure.
9.
In the popup message, click the OK button.
The update progress displays. Then a popup message appears to tell you to
reboot the VTrak.
10. In the popup message, click the OK button.
11. Restart the VTrak. See “Restarting the Subsystem” on page 215.
Note
After you click the Submit button, if WebPAM PROe displays this
message: error transferring image, you entered an incorrect file
name or an incorrect location. Check the information and try
again.
Restarting the Subsystem
Warning
Do not restart the VTrak during a firmware upgrade procedure.
Wait until the upgrade is one and you are prompted to restart.
To restart the VTrak subsystem:
1.
Click on the Subsystem
icon in Tree View.
2.
Click on the Administrative Tools
3.
Click on the Shutdown link in Management View.
icon.
A Shutdown or Restart tab will appear.
4.
On the Shutdown or Restart tab, select Restart from the dropdown menu.
5.
Click the Submit button.
6.
In the warning box, click the OK button.
7.
In the confirmation box, type the word confirm in the field provided.
8.
Click the OK button.
When the controller shuts down, your WebPAM PROe connection will be
lost.
9.
Wait for two to three minutes.
10. In your browser, log into WebPAM PROe once again.
If you cannot log in, wait for 30 seconds, and try again. Repeat until login is
successful.
215
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Updating the Firmware in the CLU
A firmware update consists of the following actions:
•
Downloading the Firmware Image File (page 216)
•
Updating the Firmware (page 216)
•
Restarting Subsystem over a Telnet Connection (page 216)
•
Restarting Subsystem over a Serial Connection (page 217)
Downloading the Firmware Image File
Go to the Promise website at http://www.promise.com/support and download the
latest firmware image file to your TFTP server.
Updating the Firmware
To update the firmware file in the CLU:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management, and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight Flash through TFTP and press Enter.
3.
Highlight TFTP Server and type the IP address of your TFTP server in the
field provided.
4.
Highlight Port Number and press the backspace key to erase the current
value, then type the new value. 69 is the default.
A list of the current users appears.
5.
Highlight File Name and type the file name of the firmware image file in the
field provided.
6.
Highlight Start and press Enter.
A message appears to tell you to reboot the VTrak.
7.
Restart the VTrak.
See “Restarting Subsystem over a Telnet Connection” on page 216 or
“Restarting Subsystem over a Serial Connection” on page 217.
Restarting Subsystem over a Telnet Connection
Warning
Do not restart the VTrak during a firmware upgrade procedure.
Wait until the upgrade is one and you are prompted to restart.
To restart the VTrak subsystem on a Telnet connection:
216
Chapter 6: Maintenance
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management, and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight Shutdown or Restart and press Enter.
3.
Press the spacebar to display Restart then press Enter.
A warning message appears.
4.
Press Y to continue.
The screen will go blank.
5.
Wait for two to three minutes.
6.
Re-establish your Telnet connection to the VTrak CLU.
If you cannot re-establish a connection, wait 30 seconds, then try again.
Restarting Subsystem over a Serial Connection
Warning
Do not restart the VTrak during a firmware upgrade procedure.
Wait until the upgrade is one and you are prompted to restart.
To restart the VTrak subsystem on a serial connection:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Additional Info and Management, and press
Enter.
2.
Highlight Shutdown or Restart and press Enter.
3.
Press the spacebar to display Restart then press Enter.
A warning message appears.
4.
Press Y to continue.
The screen will display shutdown and startup functions.
5.
When the Login: prompt appears, log into the CLU again.
217
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Replacing a Power Supply
The power supply and its fans are replaced as one unit. There are no individually
serviceable parts. No tools are required for this procedure.
Remove the Old Power Supply
To remove the power supply:
1.
Verify that the power supply LED is amber or red.
2.
Switch off the power.
3.
Unplug the power cord.
4.
Press the release button and pull the handle downward as shown. See
Figure 1 (E610f/s) or 2 (E310f/s).
5.
Pull the power supply out of the VTrak enclosure.
Install a New Power Supply
To install the power supply:
1.
Carefully slide the power supply into the enclosure.
2.
Gently press the handle in and upward until it locks. See Figure 1 (E610f/s)
or 2 (E310f/s).
3.
Plug in the power cord.
4.
Switch on the power supply.
5.
Verify that the new power supply LED is green.
Figure 1. Replacing an E610f/s power supply
218
Chapter 6: Maintenance
Figure 2. Replacing an E310f/s power supply
This completes the power supply replacement procedure.
Replacing a Cooling Unit Fan or Blower
The fan or blower in each cooling unit is replaced as an individual part. No tools
are required for this procedure.
To replace a fan or blower:
1.
Verify that the Fan LED on the cooling unit is amber or red. See Figure 3.
Figure 3. Fan LED (left: E610f/s, right: E310f/s)
Fan LED
Fan LED
2.
On the cooling unit, press the release button and pull the handle downward.
See Figure 4 (E610f/s) or 5 (E310f/s).
3.
Pull the cooling unit out of the VTrak enclosure.
219
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Figure 4. Removing a cooling unit from the E610f/s
Figure 5. Removing a cooling unit from the E310f/s
4.
Loosen the thumbscrews. A retainer keeps the thumbscrews in place.
5.
Grasp the top section near the thumbscrews and lift it off the bottom section.
Separate the cooling unit sections to access the blower. See Figure 6
(E610f/s) or 7 (E310f/s).
Figure 6. Loosen the thumbscrews and remove the cover (E610f/s)
Lift the cover
Loosen the thumbscrews
220
Chapter 6: Maintenance
Figure 7. Loosen the thumbscrews and remove the cover (E310f/s)
Lift the cover
Loosen the thumbscrews
6.
Lift the fan or blower off the mounting pins and detach the electrical
connector. See Figure 8 (E610f/s) or 9 (E310f/s).
Figure 8. The E610f/s fan and its electrical connector
Electrical
connector
Fan
221
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Figure 9. The E310f/s blower and its electrical connector
Electrical
connector
7.
Blower
Attach the electrical connector of the new fan blower and set the fan or
blower in place.
Be sure you position the fan or blower onto the mounting pins. See Figure 10
(E610f/s) or 11 (E310f/s).
Figure 10.Position the fan onto the mounting pins, pointed outward
222
Chapter 6: Maintenance
Figure 11. Positioning the blower onto the mounting pins, pointed outward
Be sure the blower points outward, towards the handle.
8.
Place the top section of the cooling unit onto the bottom section and tighten
the thumbscrews.
9.
Carefully slide the cooling unit into the enclosure.
10. Gently press the handle in and upward until it locks. See Figure 12.
Figure 12.Locking the cooling unit handle (left: E610f/s, right: E310f/s)
11. Verify that the Fan LEDs are green.
This completes the fan replacement procedure.
223
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Replacing a Cache Battery
The cache battery is located inside the cooling unit. The battery assembly is
replaced as an individual part.
Cautions
•
Try reconditioning the battery before you replace it. See
page 114 or page 161 for more information.
•
The battery assembly is replaced as a unit. Do not attempt to
disconnect the battery by itself.
•
Installing the wrong replacement battery can result in an
explosion.
•
Dispose of used batteries according to the instructions that
accompany the battery.
•
While the battery is removed, your system will be vulnerable
to data loss if the power fails while data is being written to the
logical drives.
•
If power service has failed, do not remove the cooling unit if
the Controller’s Dirty Cache LED is flashing. See “Browser
Does Not Connect to WebPAM PROe” on page 301.
To replace a cache battery:
1.
Verify that the Battery LED is amber or red. See Figure 13.
Figure 13.Fan LED (left: E610f/s, right: E310f/s)
Battery
LED
Battery LED
2.
Press the release button and pull the handle downward as shown above.
3.
Pull the cooling unit out of the VTrak enclosure. See Figure 14 (E610f/s) or
15 (E310f/s).
224
Chapter 6: Maintenance
Figure 14.Removing the cooling unit from the enclosure from the E610f/s
Figure 15.Removing the cooling unit from the enclosure from the E310f/s
3.
Loosen the thumbscrews. A retainer keeps the thumbscrews in place.
4.
Grasp the top section near the thumbscrews and lift it off the bottom section.
Separate the cooling unit sections to access the battery assemble. See
Figure 16 (E610f/s) or 17 (E310f/s).
Figure 16.Loosen the thumbscrews and remove the cover (E610f/s)
Lift the cover
Loosen the thumbscrews
225
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Figure 17.Loosen the thumbscrews and remove the cover (E310f/s)
Lift the cover
Loosen the thumbscrews
5.
Remove the two screws holding the battery assembly in place.
6.
Detach the connector on the circuit board.
Do not detach any other connectors. See Figure 18 (E610f/s) or 19
(E310f/s).
Figure 18. Removing the battery assembly (E610f/s)
Remove this screw
Detach this connector
226
Battery Assembly
Remove this screw
Chapter 6: Maintenance
Figure 19. Removing the battery assembly (E310f/s)
Remove this screw
Detach this connector
Battery Assembly
Remove this screw
7.
Lift the battery assembly out of the cooling unit.
8.
Place a new battery assembly into the cooling unit.
9.
Attach the connector on the circuit board.
10. Install the two screws holding the battery assembly in place to the cooling
unit.
11. Place the top section of the cooling unit onto the bottom section and tighten
the thumbscrews.
12. Carefully slide the cooling unit into the enclosure.
13. Gently press the handle in and upward until it locks. See Figure 20.
Figure 20.Locking the cooling unit handle (left: E610f/s, right: E310f/s)
This completes the battery replacement procedure.
227
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Replacing a RAID Controller
The RAID Controller monitors and manages the logical drives. When this
controller is replaced, all of your logical drive data and configurations remain
intact because this logical drive information is stored on the disk drives.
Caution
The RAID controller is NOT hot-swappable if your VTrak has only
one controller. Power-down the VTrak before removing it.
If your VTrak has two RAID controllers, you can hot-swap one
controller at a time.
Important
Do not replace the RAID Controller based on LED colors alone.
Only replace the RAID Controller when directed to do so by
Promise Technical Support. See page 305.
Dual Controller Subsystem
Before you install the replacement controller, be sure the replacement controller
has:
•
The same Firmware version as the original controller
•
The same amount of SDRAM as the original controller
To obtain this information, click on the Controller
look for Firmware Version and Memory Size.
icon, Information tab, and
Removing the old controller
To remove a RAID Controller on a dual-controller subsystem:
1.
Disconnect the Fibre Channel or SAS cables, management, serial, and
power cables.
2.
On the controller handle, press the release button and pull the handle
downward. See Figure 21.
3.
Pull the controller out of the VTrak enclosure.
Installing the new controller
To install the new controller:
1.
Carefully slide the controller into the enclosure.
2.
Gently press the handle in and upward until it locks. See Figure 21.
3.
Connect the Fibre Channel or SAS cables, management, serial, and power
cables.
228
Chapter 6: Maintenance
Single Controller Subsystem
Removing the old controller
To remove the RAID Controller on a single-controller subsystem:
1.
Shutdown the VTrak. See “Shutting Down the Subsystem” on page 103
(WebPAM PROe) or page 209 (CLU).
2.
Switch off the power.
3.
Disconnect the Fibre Channel or SAS cables, management, serial and
power cables.
4.
On the controller handle, press the release button and pull the handle
downward. See Figure 21.
5.
Pull the controller out of the VTrak enclosure.
Installing the new controller
To install the new controller:
1.
Carefully slide the controller into the enclosure.
2.
Gently press the handle in and upward until it locks. See Figure 21.
3.
Connect the Fibre Channel or SAS cables, management, serial and power
cables.
4.
Switch on the power.
The VTrak will restart. For more information about VTrak’s start-up behavior,
see “Connecting the Power” on page 33.
229
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Figure 21.Replacing the controller. The E310f/s is shown. The E610f/s is
similar
230
Chapter 7: Technology Background
This chapter covers the following topics:
•
Introduction to RAID (below)
•
Choosing a RAID Level (page 242)
•
Choosing Stripe Size (page 245)
•
Choosing Sector Size (page 245)
•
Cache Policy (page 246)
•
Cache Mirroring (page 248)
•
LUN Affinity (page 249)
•
Capacity Coercion (page 250)
•
Initialization (page 251)
•
Hot Spare Drive(s) (page 251)
•
Partition and Format the Logical Drive (page 252)
•
RAID Level Migration (page 252)
•
Media Patrol (page 255)
•
Predictive Data Migration (PDM) (page 256)
•
Transition (page 257)
Introduction to RAID
RAID (Redundant Array of Independent Disks) allows multiple hard drives to be
combined together in a disk array. Then all or a portion of the disk array is formed
into a logical drive. The operating system sees the logical drive as a single
storage device, and treats it as such. The RAID software and/or controller handle
all of the individual drives on its own. The benefits of a RAID can include:
•
Higher data transfer rates for increased server performance
•
Increased overall storage capacity for a single drive designation (such as, C,
D, E, etc.)
•
Data redundancy/fault tolerance for ensuring continuous system operation in
the event of a hard drive failure
Different types of disk arrays use different organizational models and have
varying benefits. Also see “Choosing a RAID Level” on page 242. The following
outline breaks down the properties for each type of RAID disk array:
231
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
RAID 0 – Stripe
When a disk array is striped, the read and write blocks of data are interleaved
between the sectors of multiple drives. Performance is increased, since the
workload is balanced between drives or “members” that form the disk array.
Identical disk drives are recommended for performance as well as data storage
efficiency. The disk array’s data capacity is equal to the number of disk drive
members multiplied by the smallest drive's capacity.
Data
Stripe
Disk Drives
Figure 1. RAID 0 Striping interleaves data across multiple drives
For example, one 100 GB and three 120 GB drives will form a 400 GB (4 x
100 GB) disk array instead of 460 GB.
RAID 0 arrays require one or more physical drives.
Recommended applications: Image Editing, Pre-Press Applications, other
applications requiring high bandwidth.
232
Chapter 7: Technology Background
RAID 1 – Mirror
When a disk array is mirrored, identical data is written to a pair of drives, while
reads are performed in parallel. The reads are performed using elevator seek
and load balancing techniques where the workload is distributed in the most
efficient manner. Whichever drive is not busy and is positioned closer to the data
will be accessed first. With RAID 1, if one drive fails or has errors, the other
mirrored drive continues to function. This is called Fault Tolerance. Moreover, if a
spare drive is present, the spare drive will be used as the replacement drive and
data will begin to be mirrored to it from the remaining good drive.
Data Mirror
Disk Drives
Figure 2. RAID 1 Mirrors identical data to two drives
Due to the data redundancy of mirroring, the drive capacity of the disk array is
only the size of the smallest drive. For example, two 100 GB drives which have a
combined capacity of 200 GB instead would have 100 GB of usable storage
when set up in a mirrored disk array. Similar to RAID 0 striping, if drives of
different capacities are used, there will also be unused capacity on the larger
drive.
RAID 1 arrays use two physical drives. You can create multiple RAID 1 disk
arrays on the same Promise product.
Recommended applications: Accounting, Payroll, Financial, other applications
requiring very high availability.
233
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
RAID 1E – Enhanced Mirror
RAID 1E offers the security of mirrored data provided by RAID 1 plus the added
capacity of more than two disk drives. It also offers overall increased read/write
performance plus the flexibility of using an odd number of disk drives. With RAID
1E, each data stripe is mirrored onto two disk drives. If one drive fails or has
errors, the other drives continue to function, providing fault tolerance.
Enhanced Data Mirrors
Disk Drives
The advantage of RAID 1E is the ability to use an odd number of disk drives,
unlike RAID 1 and RAID 10. You can also create a RAID 1E Logical Drive with an
even number of disk drives. However, if you have an even number of disks, you
will obtain greater security with comparable performance using RAID 10.
RAID 1E arrays consist of three or more physical drives. You can create an array
with just two physical drives and specify RAID 1E. But the resulting array will
actually be a RAID 1.
Recommended applications: Imaging Applications, Database Servers, General
Fileservers.
234
Chapter 7: Technology Background
RAID 5 – Block and Parity Stripe
RAID 5 organizes block data and parity data across the physical drives.
Generally, RAID Level 5 tends to exhibit lower random write performance due to
the heavy workload of parity recalculation for each I/O. RAID 5 is generally
considered to be the most versatile RAID level
Distributed Parity
Data
Blocks
Disk Drives
Figure 3. RAID 5 Stripes all drives with data and parity information
The capacity of a RAID 5 disk array is the smallest drive size multiplied by the
number of drives less one. Hence, a RAID 5 disk array with four 100 GB hard
drives will have a capacity of 300 GB. A disk array with eight 120 GB hard drives
and one 100 GB hard drive will have a capacity of 800 GB.
RAID 5 requires a minimum of three physical drives and a maximum of 16.
Recommended applications: File and Application Servers; WWW, E-mail, News
servers, Intranet Servers
235
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
RAID 6 – Block and Double Parity Stripe
RAID level 6 stores dual parity data is rotated across the physical drives along
with the block data. A RAID 6 disk array can continue to accept I/O requests
when any two physical drives fail.
Double Distributed (Wide-space Q+Q) Parity
Data
Blocks
physical drives
The total capacity of a RAID 6 disk array is the smallest physical drive times the
number of physical drives, minus two.
Hence, a RAID 6 disk array with six 100 GB hard drives will have a capacity of
400 GB. A disk logical drive with four100 GB hard drives will have a capacity of
200 GB.
RAID 6 becomes more capacity efficient in terms of physical drives as the
number of physical drives increases.
RAID 6 offers double fault tolerance. Your logical drive remains available when
up to two physical drives fail.
RAID 6 is generally considered to be the safest RAID level, except for RAID 60.
RAID 6 requires a minimum of four physical drives and a maximum of 16.
Recommended applications: Accounting, financial, and database servers; any
application requiring very high availability.
236
Chapter 7: Technology Background
RAID 10 – Mirror + Stripe
Mirroring/striping combines both of the previous RAID 1 and RAID 0 disk array
types. RAID 10 is similar though not identical to RAID 0+1. RAID 10 can increase
performance by reading and writing data in parallel while protecting data with
duplication. At least four drives are needed for RAID 10 to be installed. With four
disk drives, the drive pairs are striped together with one pair mirroring the first
pair. The data capacity is similar to a RAID 1 disk array, with half of the total
storage capacity used for redundancy. An added plus for using RAID 10 is that, in
many situations, such a disk array offers double fault tolerance. Double fault
tolerance may allow your logical drive to continue to operate depending on which
two disk drives fail.
Data Stripe
Data
Mirror
Disk Drives
Figure 4. RAID 10 takes a data mirror on one drive pair and stripes it over
two drive pairs
RAID 10 arrays require an even number of physical drives and a minimum of
four.
For RAID 10 characteristics with an odd number of disk drives, use RAID 1E.
Recommended applications: Imaging Applications, Database Servers, General
Fileservers.
237
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
RAID 50 – Striping of Distributed Parity
RAID 50 combines both RAID 5 and RAID 0 features. Data is striped across
disks as in RAID 0, and it uses distributed parity as in RAID 5. RAID 50 provides
data reliability, good overall performance and supports larger volume sizes.
Distributed Parity
Axle 1
Data
Stripes
Axle 2
Disk Drives
Figure 5. RAID 50 Striping of Distributed Parity disk arrays
RAID 50 also provides high reliability because data is still available even if
multiple disk drives fail (one in each axle). The greater the number of axles, the
greater the number of disk drives that can fail without the RAID 50 array going
offline.
RAID 50 arrays consist of six or more physical drives.
Using a VTrak E610f/s or E310f/s subsystem expanded by four J300s
subsystems, your RAID 50 array supports up to 60 physical drives. See
“Configuring JBOD Expansion” on page 24 or page 30. However, Promise
recommends that you set aside a few physical drives as hot spares. See “Hot
Spare Drive(s)” on page 251.
Recommended applications: File and Application Servers, Transaction
Processing, Office applications with many users accessing small files.
RAID 50 Axles
When you create a RAID 50, you must specify the number of axles. An axle
refers to a single RAID 5 array that is striped with other RAID 5 arrays to make
RAID 50. An axle can have from 3 to 16 physical drives, depending on the
number of physical drives in the array.
238
Chapter 7: Technology Background
The chart below shows RAID 50 arrays with 6 to 16 physical drives, the available
number of axles, and the resulting distribution of physical drives on each axle.
RAID 50 Array
No. of Drives
No. of Axles
Drives per Axle
6
2
3,3
7
2
3,4
8
2
4,4
9
2
4,5
3
3,3,3
10
2
5,5
3
3,3,4
11
2
5,6
3
3,4,4
2
6,6
12
13
14
15
16
3
4,4,4
4
3,3,3,3
2
6,7
3
4,4,5
4
3,3,3,4
2
7,7
3
4,5,5
4
3,3,4,4
2
7,8
3
5,5,5
4
3,4,4,4
5
3,3,3,3,3
2
8,8
3
5,5,6
4
4,4,4,4
5
3,3,3,3,4
239
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
RAID 60 – Striping of Double Parity
RAID 60 combines both RAID 6 and RAID 0 features. Data is striped across
disks as in RAID 0, and it uses double distributed parity as in RAID 6. RAID 60
provides data reliability, good overall performance and supports larger volume
sizes.
Double Distributed Parity
Axle 1
Data
Stripes
Axle 2
Disk Drives
Figure 6. RAID 60 Striping of Double Distributed Parity disk arrays
RAID 60 also provides very high reliability because data is still available even if
multiple disk drives fail (two in each axle). The greater the number of axles, the
greater the number of disk drives that can fail without the RAID 60 array going
offline.
RAID 60 arrays consist of eight or more physical drives.
Using a VTrak E610f/s or E310f/s subsystem expanded by four J300s
subsystems, your RAID 60 array supports up to 60 physical drives. See
“Configuring JBOD Expansion” on page 24 or page 30. However, Promise
recommends that you set aside a few physical drives as hot spares. See “Hot
Spare Drive(s)” on page 251.
Recommended applications: Accounting, financial, and database servers; any
application requiring very high availability.
RAID 60 Axles
When you create a RAID 60, you must specify the number of axles. An axle
refers to a single RAID 6 array that is striped with other RAID 6 arrays to make
RAID 60. An axle can have from 4 to 16 physical drives, depending on the
number of physical drives in the array.
The chart below shows RAID 60 arrays with 8 to 20 physical drives, the available
number of axles, and the resulting distribution of physical drives on each axle.
240
Chapter 7: Technology Background
RAID 60 Array
No. of Drives
No. of Axles
Drives per Axle
8
2
4,4
9
2
4,5
10
2
5,5
11
2
5,6
12
2
6,6
3
4,4,4
2
6,7
3
4,4,5
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
2
7,7
3
4,5,5
2
7,8
3
5,5,5
2
8,8
3
5,5,6
4
4,4,4,4
2
8,9
3
5,6,6
4
4,4,4,5
2
9,9
3
6,6,6
4
4,4,5,5
2
9,10
3
6,6,7
4
4,5,5,5
2
10,10
3
6,7,7
4
5,5,5,5
5
4,4,4,4,4
241
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Choosing a RAID Level
There are several issues to consider when choosing the RAID Level for your
VTrak disk array. The following discussion summarizes some advantages,
disadvantages, and applications for each choice.
RAID 0
Advantages
Disadvantages
Implements a striped disk array, the
data is broken down into blocks and
each block is written to a separate disk
drive
I/O performance is greatly improved by
spreading the I/O load across many
channels and drives
No parity calculation overhead is
involved
Not a true RAID because it is not faulttolerant
The failure of just one drive will result in
all data in an disk array being lost
Should not be used in mission critical
environments
Recommended Applications for RAID 0
•
Image Editing
•
Pre-Press Applications
•
Any application requiring high bandwidth
RAID 1
Advantages
Disadvantages
Simplest RAID storage subsystem
design
Can increase read performance by
processing data requests in parallel
since the same data resides on two
different drives
Very high disk overhead - uses only
50% of total capacity
Recommended Applications for RAID 1
•
Accounting
•
Payroll
•
Financial
•
Any application requiring very high availability
242
Chapter 7: Technology Background
RAID 1E
Advantages
Disadvantages
Implemented as a mirrored disk array
whose segments are RAID 0 disk
arrays
High I/O rates are achieved thanks to
multiple stripe segments
Can use an odd number of disks
Very high disk overhead - uses only
50% of total capacity
Recommended Applications for RAID 1E
•
Imaging applications
•
Database servers
•
General fileserver
RAID 5
Advantages
Disadvantages
High Read data transaction rate
Medium Write data transaction rate
Good aggregate transfer rate
Disk failure has a medium impact on
throughput
Recommended Applications for RAID 5
•
File and Application servers
•
Intranet servers
•
WWW, E-mail, and News servers
•
Most versatile RAID level
RAID 6
Advantages
Disadvantages
High Read data transaction rate
Medium Write data transaction rate
Good aggregate transfer rate
Safest RAID level, except for RAID 60
High disk overhead – equivalent of two
drives used for parity
Slightly lower performance than RAID 5
Recommended Applications for RAID 6
•
Accounting and Financial
•
Database servers
•
Any application requiring very high availability
243
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
RAID 10
Advantages
Disadvantages
Implemented as a mirrored disk array
whose segments are RAID 0 disk
arrays
High I/O rates are achieved thanks to
multiple stripe segments
Very high disk overhead - uses only
50% of total capacity
Recommended Applications for RAID 10
•
Imaging applications
•
Database servers
•
General fileserver
RAID 50
Advantages
Disadvantages
High Read data transaction rate
Medium Write data transaction rate
Good aggregate transfer rate
High reliability
Supports large volume sizes
Higher disk overhead than RAID 5
Recommended Applications for RAID 50
•
File and Application servers
•
Transaction processing
•
Office application with many users accessing small files
RAID 60
Advantages
Disadvantages
High Read data transaction rate
Medium Write data transaction rate
Good aggregate transfer rate
Safest RAID level
High disk overhead – equivalent of two
drives used for parity
Slightly lower performance than RAID
50
Recommended Applications for RAID 60:
•
Accounting and Financial
•
Database servers
•
Any application requiring very high availability
244
Chapter 7: Technology Background
Choosing Stripe Size
Stripe Size, also called “Stripe Block Size”, refers to the size of the data blocks
written to, and read from, the physical drives. Stripe Size is specified when you
create a disk array. In order to change the Stripe Size of an existing disk array,
you must delete the disk array and create a new one. You can select Stripe Size
directly when you use the Advanced function to create a disk array. If you use the
Express function to create a disk array, WebPAM PRO selects the Stripe Size
when you choose an Application Type.
The available Stripe Sizes are 64, 128, 256 KB, 512 KB, and 1 MB. 64 KB is the
default. There are two issues to consider when selecting the Stripe Size.
First, you should choose a Stripe Size equal to, or smaller than, the smallest
cache buffer found on any physical drive in the disk array. Selecting a larger
value slows read/write performance because physical drives with smaller cache
buffers need more time for multiple accesses to fill their buffers.
Second, if your data retrieval consists of fixed data blocks, such as with some
database or video applications, then you should choose that size as your Stripe
Size.
If you do not know the cache buffer or fixed data block sizes, Promise suggests
you select 64 KB as your Stripe Size. Generally speaking, email, POS, and
webservers prefer smaller stripe sizes. Video and database applications prefer
larger stripe sizes.
Choosing Sector Size
A sector is the smallest addressable area on a physical disk drive. Sector Size
refers to the size of sector measured by the number of bytes of data it can hold.
The most common sector size is 512 bytes (512 B). A smaller sector size results
in a more efficient use of a disk drive’s capacity. 512 B is the default sector size
for logical drives on VTrak.
The number of usable sectors is limited by the addressing method of the
computer's operating system:
•
Windows 2000 and Windows XP (32-bit) support 10-bit logical bit addressing
(LBA), so with 512 B sectors, they can only support up to 2 terabytes (TB) of
data storage capacity. To increase the capacity, you must use larger sectors.
See “2 TB Limitation” on page 246.
•
Windows XP (64-bit), Windows 2003 Server, and Windows Vista support 64bit LBA, so they are not affected by this limitation. For these OSes, always
choose the default 512 B sector size.
•
Linux operating systems with the 2.4 kernel do not support variable sector
sizes. For these OSes, always choose the default 512 B sector size.
245
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
•
Linux operating systems with the 2.6 kernel support 64-bit LBA. For these
OSes, always choose the default 512 B sector size.
2 TB Limitation
If your Host PC runs Windows 2000 or Windows XP (32-bit), and you want to
create logical drives larger than 2TB, you must choose a sector size larger than
512 B when you create the logical drive. The table below correlates sector size
with logical drive capacity.
Logical Drive Size
Sector Size
8 to 16 TB
4096 bytes (4 KB)
4 to 8 TB
2048 bytes (2 KB)
2 to 4 TB
1024 bytes (1 KB)
0 to 2 TB
512 bytes (512 B)
Because logical drives can be expanded, you may encounter a situation where
the usable capacity of your expanded logical drive is reduced by the addressing
issue described above. There are two alternatives:
•
Limit your logical drive expansion to within the limits described in the chart.
•
Back up your data, then delete your existing logical drive and create a new
one with a larger sector size.
Cache Policy
As it is used with VTrak, the term cache refers to any of several kinds of highspeed, volatile memory that hold data moving from your computer to the physical
drives or vice-versa. Cache is important because it can read and write data much
faster than a physical drive. There are read caches, which hold data as it is read
from a physical drive; and write caches, which hold data as it is written to a
physical drive.
In order to tune the cache for best performance in different applications, useradjustable settings are provided. Cache settings are made in conjunction with
logical drives:
•
When you create a logical drive. See “Creating a Logical Drive” on page 127
or page 174
•
On an existing logical drive. See “Making Logical Drive Settings” on
page 136 or “Setting Write Cache Policy” on page 176
246
Chapter 7: Technology Background
Read Cache Policy
•
Read Cache – The read cache is enabled.
•
Read Ahead – The read cache and the read-ahead feature are enabled.
Read-ahead anticipates the next read and performs it before the request is
made. Can increase read performance.
•
No Cache – The read cache is disabled.
Write Cache Policy
•
Write Back – Data is written first to the cache, then to the logical drive.
Better performance. VTrak has a cache backup battery to protect data in the
cache from a sudden power failure.
•
Write Thru – Also “Write Through”. Data is written to the cache and the
logical drive at the same time. Safer.
If your write cache policy is set to Write Back, the write policy automatically
changes to Write Thru when all of the following conditions occur:
•
The logical drive write policy is set to Write Back
•
The Adaptive Writeback Cache feature is enabled
•
The cache backup battery goes offline
When the battery comes back online, the write policy automatically changes back
to Write Back.
Also see “Cache Mirroring” on page 248.
Adaptive Writeback Cache
On the VTrak subsystem, you can set the logical drive write cache policy to Write
Thru or Write Back.
If you set the write cache policy to Write Back, your data is first written to the
controller cache, and later to the logical drive. This action improves performance.
To preserve the data in the cache in the event of a power failure, the subsystem
has a backup battery that powers the cache. To see an estimate of how long the
battery will power the cache, see “Checking the Batteries” on page 113 or
page 160.
The Adaptive Writeback Cache feature protects your data by changing the write
cache settings while the cache backup battery is offline. When all of the following
conditions occur:
•
The logical drive write policy is set to Write Back
•
The Adaptive Writeback Cache feature is enabled
•
The cache backup battery goes offline
247
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
The write policy automatically changes to Write Thru. When the battery comes
back online, the write policy automatically changes back to Write Back.
To enable the Adaptive Writeback Cache option, see “Making Controller Settings”
on page 107 or page 156.
Also see “Replacing a Cache Battery” on page 224.
Cache Mirroring
VTrak subsystems with two controllers include a Cache Mirroring feature. Cache
Mirroring causes the local controller to mirror write data to the remote controller.
That means, when there is write data in the cache of the controller managing the
target logical drive, the same write data is copied to the cache of the other
controller as well. This arrangement protects the data from loss, in the event that
the local controller fails before the data is written to the logical drive.
Cache Mirroring works whether the write cache policy of your logical drives is set
to Write Back or Write Through. However, you only realize the advantage of
Cache Mirroring when the write cache policy is set to Write Back.
With Cache Mirroring enabled, any write data in the controller cache that has not
been written to the logical drive, will be written to the logical drive, even if the
controller fails. Enable Cache Mirroring when you require failover/failback
protection.
With Cache Mirroring disabled, any write data in the controller cache that has
not been written to the logical drive, will be lost if the controller fails. On the other
hand, write performance increases because of greater bandwidth. Disable Cache
Mirroring when you require maximum performance.
To use Cache Mirroring you must:
•
Have two controllers in the subsystem
•
Set Redundancy Type to Active-Active.
See “Setting Redundancy for the Subsystem” on page 62 or page 152
•
Enable Cache Mirroring under subsystem settings.
See “Setting Redundancy for the Subsystem” on page 62 or page 152
On subsystems with two controllers, when Cache Mirroring is disabled, LUN
Affinity is enabled automatically. See “LUN Affinity” on page 249
Failover and Failback
When one controller fails, the surviving controller takes over logical drive access
until the failed controller is brought back online or is replaced. For example,
Cache Mirroring is enabled and your logical drives are assigned to Controller 1.
The following actions will happen:
248
Chapter 7: Technology Background
•
If Controller 1 goes offline, Controller 2 takes over access to the logical
drives assigned to Controller 1.
•
All write data that is still in the controller cache will be written to the logical
drives, even though the controller managing them has failed.
•
If Controller 1 comes back online, Controller 1 takes back access to the
logical drives assigned to it.
•
If Controller 1 is replaced, the new controller takes over access to the logical
drives assigned to Controller 1.
LUN Affinity
VTrak subsystems with two controllers include a LUN Affinity feature. Normally,
either controller can access all logical drives. LUN Affinity enables you to specify
which controller can access each logical drive. Use this feature to balance the
load of your logical drives between the two controllers.
To use LUN Affinity you must:
•
Have two controllers in the subsystem
•
Enable LUN Affinity under controller settings. See page 107 or page 156
On subsystems with two controllers, when Cache Mirroring is disabled, LUN
Affinity is enabled automatically. See “Cache Mirroring” on page 248.
Disk Array Creation
When you create a logical drive using the Advanced method of disk array
creation, you can specify the Preferred Controller ID:
•
Controller 1 – Assign all logical drives to Controller 1
•
Controller 2 – Assign all logical drives to Controller 2
•
Automatic – Alternate logical drive assignments between Controllers 1 and 2
Automatic is the default and preferred setting because it will balance the logical
drive assignments for you.
When you create a logical drive using the Automatic or Express disk array
creation, the logical drives are assigned alternatively between Controllers 1 and 2
automatically.
See “Creating a Disk Array – Automatic” on page 122, “Creating a Disk Array –
Express” on page 122, or “Creating a Disk Array – Advanced” on page 123.
249
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Logical Drive Settings
After you have created a logical drive, you can click on the Settings tab and
manually change the Preferred Controller ID between Controller 1 and Controller
2. See “Making Logical Drive Settings” on page 136.
If you create logical drives with LUN Affinity disabled, the Preferred Controller ID
will show N/A, and your logical drives will be visible to both controllers.
If you create logical drives with LUN Affinity disabled, and later you enable LUN
Affinity, all of your logical drives will be assigned to Controller 1. To balance the
load, you can reassign some of your logical drives to Controller 2 under the
Preferred Controller ID in the Settings tab. See “Making Logical Drive Settings”
on page 136.
When you a delete a logical drive, the remaining logical drives keep the same
Controller assignments. If you want to rebalance controller assignments of the
remaining logical drives, change their Preferred Controller IDs in the Settings tab.
Failover and Failback
When one controller fails, the surviving controller takes over logical drive access
until the failed controller is brought back online or is replaced. For example, LUN
Affinity is enabled and your logical drives are assigned to Controller 1. The
following actions will happen:
•
If Controller 1 goes offline, Controller 2 takes over access to the logical
drives assigned to Controller 1.
•
If Controller 1 comes back online, Controller 1 takes back access to the
logical drives assigned to it.
•
If Controller 1 is replaced, the new controller takes over access to the logical
drives assigned to Controller 1.
•
All logical drives assigned to Controller 2 remain accessible by Controller 2.
Controller 1 cannot access them at any time.
Capacity Coercion
This feature is designed for fault-tolerant logical drives (RAID 1, 1E, 5, 10, 50,
and 60). It is generally recommended to use physical drives of the same size in
your disk arrays. When this is not possible, physical drives of different sizes will
work but the system must adjust for the size differences by reducing or coercing
the capacity of the larger drives to match the smaller ones. With VTrak, you can
choose to enable Capacity Coercion and any one of four methods.
Enable Capacity Coercion and select the Method in the Controller Settings menu.
See page 107. The choices are:
250
Chapter 7: Technology Background
•
GB Truncate – (Default) Reduces the useful capacity to the nearest
1,000,000,000 byte boundary.
•
10GB Truncate – Reduces the useful capacity to the nearest 10,000,000,000
byte boundary.
•
Group Rounding – Uses an algorithm to determine how much to truncate.
Results in the maximum amount of usable drive capacity.
•
Table Rounding – Applies a predefined table to determine how much to
truncate.
Capacity Coercion also affects a replacement drive used in a disk array.
Normally, when an physical drive fails, the replacement drive must be the same
capacity or larger. However, the Capacity Coercion feature permits the
installation of a replacement drive that is slightly smaller (within 1 gigabyte) than
the remaining working drive. For example, the remaining working drives can be
80.5 GB and the replacement drive can be 80.3, since all are rounded down to
80 GB. This permits the smaller drive to be used.
Without Capacity Coercion, the controller will not permit the use of a replacement
physical drive that is slightly smaller than the remaining working drive(s).
Initialization
Initialization is done to logical drives after they are created from a disk array.
Initialization sets all data bits in the logical drive to zero. The action is useful
because there may be residual data on the logical drives left behind from earlier
configurations. For this reason, Initialization is recommended for all new logical
drives. See “Initializing a Logical Drive” on page 137.
Caution
When you initialize a logical drive, all the data on the logical drive
will be lost. Backup any important data before you initialize a
logical drive.
Hot Spare Drive(s)
A hot spare is a disk drive that is connected to the disk array system but is not
assigned as a member of the disk array. In the event of the failure of a drive
within a functioning fault tolerant disk array, the hot spare is activated as a
member of the disk array to replace a drive that has failed.
VTrak will replace a failing disk drive in a disk array with an unassigned drive, if
one is available. The unassigned drive is not part of any disk array. Such a drive
is called a hot spare drive. There are two types:
•
Global – An unassigned disk drive available to any disk array on the VTrak.
251
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
•
Dedicated – An unassigned disk drive that can only be used by a specified
disk array.
The hot spare policy function lets you select whether a disk array will access any
unassigned disk drive or a designated drive in the event of disk drive failure. See
“Managing Spare Drives” on page 141 (WebPAM PROe) or page 190 (CLU) for
information on how to make this setting.
The spare drive effectively takes the place of the failed drive and the RAID
system immediately begins to rebuild data onto the drive. When the rebuild is
complete, the disk array is returned to fault tolerant status.
VTrak includes a function that enables you to return a hot spare drive from a disk
array back to spare status. When you create the hot spare drive, check the
Revertible box to enable this feature. See “Transition” on page 257.
See also “Critical & Offline Disk Arrays” on page 289.
Partition and Format the Logical Drive
Like any other type of fixed disk media in your system, a RAID logical drive must
also be partitioned and formatted before use. Use the same method of
partitioning and formatting on an logical drive as you would any other fixed disk.
Depending on the operating system you use, there may or may not be various
capacity limitations applicable for the different types of partitions.
RAID Level Migration
To migrate a disk array is to do one or both:
•
Change its RAID level
•
Increase the number of disk drives (sometimes called Expansion)
Migration takes place on an existing Functional disk array without disturbing the
existing data. While the disk array is migrating, you can access the data as
before. When migration is complete, your disk array will have a different RAID
level and/or a larger capacity.
252
Chapter 7: Technology Background
Different types of disk arrays use different organizational models and have
varying benefits. The following outline breaks down the properties for each type
of RAID supported by Promise products.
From
RAID 50
To
RAID 10
Increase
Capacity
Redundancy
Performance
Add
•
RAID 5
•*
RAID 1E
RAID 10
RAID 5
RAID 1E
RAID 1
RAID 0
•
RAID 0
•
RAID 50
•
RAID 5
•
RAID 1E
•
RAID 0
•
•
•
•
•
RAID 50
•
RAID 10
•
RAID 1E
•
RAID 0
•
RAID 50
•
RAID 10
•
RAID 5
•
RAID 0
•
RAID 50
•
•
•
•
•
•
RAID 10
•
RAID 5
•
RAID 1E
•
RAID 0
•
RAID 50
•
•
RAID 10
•
•
•
•
RAID 5
RAID 1E
Lose
•
•
•
•
RAID 1
•
* Decreases the existing redundancy
253
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Important
•
The Target disk array may require more disk drives than the
Source disk array
•
If the Target disk array requires an EVEN number of disk
drives but the Source disk array has an ODD number, ADD a
disk drive as part of the migration process
•
You cannot reduce the number of disk drives in your disk
array, even if the Target disk array requires fewer disk drives
than the Source disk array
•
RAID 1 (mirroring) works with two drives only. Only a singledrive RAID 0 disk array or a single-drive JBOD can migrate to
RAID 1. Other RAID Levels use too many drives to migrate
•
You cannot migrate a disk array when it is Critical or
performing activities such as Synchronizing, Rebuilding, and
PDM
•
You cannot migrate to or from RAID 6 or RAID 60. You must
create a new disk array and move your data to it
Ranges of Disk Array Expansion
The Windows 2000 and Windows XP (32-bit) operating systems support a 10byte LBA format. As a result, these OSes can only recognize 4 billion addresses.
If you create a logical drive using the default 512 B sector size, the logical drive
will be limited to 2 TB of data, even if there is more space available on your disk
drives.
This limitation does not apply to Windows XP (64-bit), 2003 Server, Vista, and
Linux OSes with the 2.6 kernel. Linux OSes with the 2.4 kernel do not support
variable sector sizes, therefore you cannot apply the solution described here to
those OSes.
Note that once you create your logical drive, you cannot change the size of the
sectors. Nor can you increase the number of address blocks that the OS
recognizes.
You can direct WebPAM PROe to expand a logical drive beyond the maximum
expansion size. When the expansion is finished:
•
WebPAM PROe will show the logical drive in the desired size.
•
Your operating system might show the logical drive at the maximum size
listed in the table below.
•
Additional capacity might appear as unpartitioned and unformatted.
254
Chapter 7: Technology Background
Current LD Size
Maximum LD
Expansion Size
8 to 16 TB
16 TB
4096 bytes
4 to 8 TB
8 TB
2048 bytes
2 to 4 TB
4 TB
1024 bytes
up to 2 TB
2 TB
512 bytes
Sector Size
At this point, you have the choice of:
•
Format the unpartitioned/unformatted capacity as a second logical drive
•
Delete the existing disk array and create a new one in the desired size
Delete and Recreate
If you require a logical drive larger than the maximum expansion size:
1.
2.
Backup the data from the current logical drive.
Delete the current logical drive.
See page 129 (WebPAM PROe) or page 175 (CLU).
3.
Create a new logical drive with the desired capacity.
See page 127 (WebPAM PROe) or page 174 (CLU).
4.
Restore the data to the new logical drive.
Media Patrol
Media Patrol is a routine maintenance procedure that checks the magnetic media
on each disk drive. Media Patrol checks all physical drives assigned to disk
arrays. Media Patrol does not check unconfigured drives.
Media Patrol will also check spare drives, if those drives have Media Patrol
enabled. Media Patrol for spare drives is enabled by default. You can disable it in
VTrak’s Command Line Interface (CLI).
Unlike Synchronization and Redundancy Check, Media Patrol is concerned with
the condition of the media itself, not the data recorded on the media. If Media
Patrol encounters a critical error, it triggers PDM if PDM is enabled.
You can run Media Patrol from the subsystem. See “Running Media Patrol” on
page 68 (WebPAM PROe) or page 153 (CLU).
You can also run Media Patrol on a disk array. See “Running Media Patrol on a
Disk Array” on page 131 (WebPAM PROe) or page 171 (CLU).
255
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Predictive Data Migration (PDM)
Predictive Data Migration (PDM) is the migration of data from the suspect disk
drive to a spare disk drive, similar to Rebuilding a Logical Drive. But unlike
Rebuilding, PDM constantly monitors your disk drives and automatically copies
your data to a spare disk drive before the disk drive fails and your Logical Drive
goes Critical. See “Running PDM” on page 68 for WebPAM PROe or page 173
for the CLU.
After the data is copied from the suspect disk drive, the controller marks it with a
Stale configuration and a PFA error.
You can clear the Stale configuration and PFA error and put the disk drive back
into service. See “Clearing Stale and PFA Conditions” on page 119 for WebPAM
PROe or page 163 for the CLU. In some cases, however, you might remove the
disk drive for repair or replacement.
PDM Triggers
The following actions trigger PDM:
•
A disk drive with unhealthy status (see below)
•
Media Patrol finds a disk critical error*
•
You initiate PDM manually
*PDM also counts the number of media errors reported by Media Patrol.
A disk drive becomes unhealthy when:
•
A SMART error is reported
•
The bad sector remapping table fills to the specified level
Because data would be lost if written to a bad sector, when a bad sector is
detected, the disk drive creates a map around it. These maps are saved in the
bad sector remapping table, which has a capacity of 512 reassigned blocks and
1024 error blocks.
When the table fills to a specified percentage of its capacity, PDM triggers a
migration of data from the suspect drive (the disk drive with the bad sectors) to a
spare disk drive.
During data migration, you will have access to the Logical Drive but it will respond
more slowly to read/write tasks because of the additional operation. The time
required for data migration depends on the size of the disk drive.
See “Making Background Activity Settings” on page 66 (WebPAM PROe) or
page 186 (CLU).
256
Chapter 7: Technology Background
Transition
The Transition feature enables you to specify “permanent” spare drives for your
VTrak subsystem. Transition is the process of replacing a revertible spare drive
that is currently part of a disk array with an unconfigured physical drive or a nonrevertible spare. The revertible spare drive returns to its original status.
Transition happens automatically when the following sequence of events takes
place:
•
You create a revertible spare drive.
•
A physical drive assigned to your disk array fails and the array goes critical
or degraded.
•
VTrak automatically rebuilds your array to the revertible spare drive and the
array becomes functional again.
•
You replace the failed physical drive with a new physical drive of equal or
greater capacity.
•
VTrak automatically transitions (moves) the data from the revertible spare to
the new physical drive.
•
The new physical drive becomes part of the array and the revertible spare
drive returns to its original spare status.
See page 142 (WebPAM PROe) or page 190 (CLU).
Transition happens manually when you specify a different unconfigured physical
drive to transition (move) the data from the revertible spare drive.
See the example below.
Example
Following is an example to explain the Transition function.
257
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
In the example above, there is a four-drive RAID 5 disk array and a global spare
drive. Physical drives 1, 2, 3, and 4 belong to the disk array. Physical drive 5
remains unconfigured. Physical drive 6 is a revertible spare drive.
If a physical drive fails in a disk array and there is a spare drive of adequate
capacity available, the controller automatically rebuilds the array using the spare
drive. In this example, physical drive 3 failed and the array is rebuilt using
physical drive 6, the revertible spare drive.
When the rebuild is complete, the spare drive has replaced the failed drive. In this
example, failed drive 3 was replaced by spare drive 6. The disk array now
consists of physical drives 1, 2, 4, and 6.
There is no spare drive at this moment. Even if physical drive 5 is of adequate
capacity, it has not been designated as a spare, therefore the controller cannot
use it as a spare.
258
Chapter 7: Technology Background
Automatic Transition
At this juncture, you would replace the failed drive in slot 3 with a new one of the
same or greater capacity.
When the VTrak controller detects the new drive in slot 3, it will:
•
Automatically transition the data on drive 6 to drive 3
•
Return drive 6 to spare status
When the Automatic Transition is finished, physical drives 1, 2, 3, and 4 belong to
the disk array and physical drive 6 is a revertible spare drive. The original
configuration is restored.
Manual Transition
If you wanted to use the drive in slot 5 as a member of the disk array, rather than
the drive in slot 3, you would run the Transition function manually. See page 132
(WebPAM PROe) or page 173 (CLU).
When the Manual Transition is finished, physical drives 1, 2, 4, and 5 belong to
the disk array and physical drive 6 is a revertible spare drive.
At this point, you would replace the drive in slot 3. The new drive in slot 3 will be
unconfigured until you assign it to a disk array or as a spare.
259
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
260
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting
This chapter covers the following topics:
•
VTrak is Beeping (page 262)
•
LEDs Display Amber or Red (page 263)
•
CLU Reports a Problem (page 269)
•
WebPAM PROe Reports a Problem (page 271)
•
LEDs Display Amber or Red (page 263)
•
Event Notification Response (page 274)
•
Critical & Offline Disk Arrays (page 289)
•
Incomplete Array (page 292)
•
Physical Drive Problems (page 293)
•
Enclosure Problems (page 295)
•
Controller Enters Maintenance Mode (page 298)
•
Connection Problems (page 299)
•
Browser Does Not Connect to WebPAM PROe (page 301)
•
Unsaved Data in the Controller Cache (page 302)
261
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
VTrak is Beeping
VTrak’s alarm has five different patterns, as shown below.
Figure 1. Audible alarm sound patters
1
.25s .25s .25s
2
.25s
3
.25s
4
.25s .25s .25s
1x
.75s
.5s
.25s
.75s
2.5s
.25s
.25s
.5s
6s
.25s
.75s
.25s
1s
.25s
5
1.25s
.25s
3s
2x
8
s
When you first power-up the VTrak, it beeps twice to show normal operation.
The audible alarm sounds at other times to inform you that the VTrak needs
attention. But the alarm does not specify the condition. When the alarm sounds:
•
Check the front and back of VTrak for red or amber LEDs, as described
above.
•
If email notification is enabled, check for new messages.
•
Check for yellow !s
•
Check the event log. See page 63 (WebPAM PROe) or page 188 (CLU).
red Xs
in Tree View (see page 271).
When a continuous tone sounds, there are multiple alarm patterns sounding at
the same time.
To make alarm settings or cancel an alarm, see page 114 (WebPAM PROe) or
page 212 (CLU).
262
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting
LEDs Display Amber or Red
Front Panel
When the power is switched on, the LEDs on the front of the VTrak will light up.
Figure 2. VTrak front panel LED display. The E310f/s is shown. the E610f/s
is similar
Power
FRU Status
Logical Drive Status
RAID Controller 1 Activity
RAID Controller 2 Activity
Controller Heartbeat
When boot-up is finished and the VTrak is functioning normally:
•
Controller Heartbeat LED blinks once every two seconds.
•
Power, FRU and Logical Drive LEDs display green continuously.
•
The RAID Controller LEDs flash green if there is activity on that controller.
See the table below.
263
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
State
LEDs
Dark
Steady
Green
Flashing
Green
Power
System Off
Normal
FRU*
System Off
Normal
Fan, battery Fan, battery
or PSU
or PSU
Problem
Failed
Logical
Drive
System Off
Normal
Logical
Logical
Drive Critical Drive Offline
Controller
Activity
No Activity
Activity
Controller
Heartbeat
System Off
Normal**
Amber
Red
* Field Replacement Unit: includes fan, battery, and power supply unit (PSU).
** Blinks once every two seconds.
See page 213 for more information about field-replaceable components.
See page 289 for a discussion of critical and offline logical drives.
Drive Status Indicators
There are two LEDs on each Drive Carrier. They report the presence of power
and a disk drive, and the current condition of the drive.
The VTrak spins up the disk drives sequentially in order to equalize power draw
during start-up. After a few moments the Power/Activity and Disk Status LEDs
should display green.
Figure 3. VTrak drive carrier LEDs
Disk Status
Power/Activity
264
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting
State
LEDs
Dark
Steady
Green
Flashing
Green
Power/
Activity
No Drive
Drive
Present
Activity
Status
No Power/
No Drive
Drive OK
Amber
Red
Drive
Rebuilding
Drive
Error
See “Critical & Offline Disk Arrays” on page 289 for a discussion of rebuilding and
failed disk drives.
Back of Enclosure
When the FRU Status LED on VTrak’s front panel shows Amber or Red, check
the LEDs on the back of VTrak. These LEDs give the status of the field
replaceable units.
Figure 1. VTrak E610f rear view
RAID Controller 1
Mgmt
FC 1
4
2
FC 2
RAID Controller 2
Mgmt
UPS
FC 1
4
2
1
1
Gb/s
Gb/s
4
2
115200
8N1
FC 2
UPS
4
2
1
1
Gb/s
Gb/s
115200
8N1
Power Supply 1 Cooling Unit 1 Cooling Unit 2 Power Supply 2
with Battery
with Battery
265
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Figure 2. VTrak E610s rear view
RAID Controller 1
RAID Controller 2
Mgmt
Mgmt
UPS
115200
8N1
UPS
115200
8N1
Power Supply 1 Cooling Unit 1 Cooling Unit 2 Power Supply 2
with Battery
with Battery
Figure 4. VTrak E310f rear view
Cooling Unit 1
Power Supply 1 with Battery
Cooling Unit 2
Power Supply 2
with Battery
I
I
O
O
Mgmt
FC 1
FC 2
4
2
Mgmt
UPS
FC 1
4
2
1
1
Gb/s
Gb/s
4
2
115200
8N1
RAID Controller 1
FC 2
UPS
4
2
1
1
Gb/s
Gb/s
115200
8N1
RAID Controller 2
Figure 5. VTrak E310s rear view
Cooling Unit 1
Power Supply 1 with Battery
Cooling Unit 2
Power Supply 2
with Battery
I
I
O
O
Mgmt
Mgmt
UPS
115200
8N1
UPS
115200
8N1
RAID Controller 1
RAID Controller 2
266
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting
Figure 6. Battery and Fan LEDs (left: E610f/s, right: E310f/s)
Battery
LED
Fan
LED
Fan LED
Battery LED
Under normal conditions, the power supply and fan LEDs should display green.
State
LEDs
Dark
Green
Amber
Red
Power supply
Not detected
OK
Fan failed
Failed
Battery
Not detected
OK
Fan
Not detected
OK
Wrong speed
Failed
To check a component’s installation, follow the same procedure as replacing the
component, except that you reinstall the original component rather than a new
one. In most cases, this action fixes a bad connection and allows VTrak to detect
the component. If this action does not correct the problem, replace the unit. See
page 213 for instructions.
The Controller Location LEDs, on the back of the VTrak subsystem, will flash for
one minute.
Figure 7. The VTrak E610f/E310f controller LEDs
Mgmt
FC 1
4
FC 2
2
UPS
4
2
1
1
Gb/s
Gb/s
Status LED
Dirty Cache LED
267
115200
8N1
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Figure 8. The VTrak E610f/E310s controller LEDs
Mgmt
UPS
115200
8N1
Status LED
Dirty Cache LED
Under normal conditions, the Controller Status LED (marked with
icon) is
green and the Dirty Cache LED (marked with
) icon is dark. See the table
below.
State
LEDs
Dark
Green
Amber
Status
no power
OK
Error
Dirty Cache
OK
Unsaved data
in cache
Flashing
Amber
OK
If the Controller Status LED is amber, restart the VTrak. See “Restarting the
Subsystem” on page 104 or page 211.
If the Controller Status LED continues to display amber after startup, contact
Promise Technical Support. See “Contacting Technical Support” on page 305.
The Dirty Cache LED flashes during input/output operation. If the LED shines
amber and the power is off, there is unsaved data in the cache. Do NOT power
down the VTrak while this LED is on. See “Browser Does Not Connect to
WebPAM PROe” on page 301 for more information.
268
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting
CLU Reports a Problem
The CLU reports information passively—you must determine which functions to
check based on the sound of the VTrak’s audible alarm (see page 262) and any
amber or red LEDs (see page 263).
Check the event logs first. Then check the reported component.
Viewing Runtime Events
To display Runtime Events:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Event Viewer and press Enter.
The log of Runtime Events appears. Events are added to the top of the list.
Each item includes:
•
Sequence number – Begins with 0 at system startup.
•
Device – Disk Array, Logical Drive, Physical Drive by its ID number.
•
Severity – (lowest to highest) Information, Warning, Minor, Major,
Critical and Fatal
•
Timestamp – Date and time the event happened.
•
Description – A description of the event in plain language.
Press the up and down arrow keys to scroll through the log.
Viewing NVRAM Events
This screen displays a list of and information about 63 most important events
over multiple subsystem startups.
To display NVRAM events:
1.
From the Main Menu, highlight Event Viewer and press Enter.
2.
Highlight NVRAM Events and press Enter.
The log of NVRAM Events appears. Events are added to the top of the list.
Each item includes:
3.
•
Sequence number – Begins with 0 at system startup.
•
Device – Disk Array, Logical Drive, Physical Drive by its ID number.
•
Severity – (lowest to highest) Information, Warning, Minor, Major,
Critical and Fatal
•
Timestamp – Date and time the event happened.
•
Description – A description of the event in plain language.
Press the up and down arrow keys to scroll through the log.
269
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Checking a Reported Component
In this example, let us check disk array status.
1.
Open the CLU.
2.
Highlight Disk Array Management and press Enter.
3.
Observe the status of your disk arrays.
DaId Alias OpStatus CfgCapacity FreeCapacity MaxContiguousCap
------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------0
DA0 OK
75.44GB
66.06GB
66.06GB
1
DA1 Degraded 189.06GB
179.68GB
179.68GB
2
DA2 OK
73.57GB
64.20GB
64.20GB
At this point, you can highlight the Degraded array and press Enter to see more
information. See below.
Disk Array ID
:
OperationalStatus
:
FreeCapacity
:
SupportedRAIDLevels:
Disk Array Alias
MediaPatrol
PDM
1
Degraded
179.68 GB
0 5 10 1E
Physical Capacity
: 189.06GB
MaxContiguousCapacity : 11.18GB
ConfigurableCapacity
: 179.68GB
: DA1
: Enabled
: Enabled
Transport
Rebuild
Predictive Data Migration
Transition
Dedicated Spare Drives in the Array
Physical Drives in the Array
Logical Drives in the Array
[Locate Disk Array]
Save Settings
[CTRL-A]
Restore Settings
[CTRL-R]
Return to Previous Menu
From this screen:
•
Highlight Physical Drives in the Array and press Enter to identify the failed
disk drive
•
Highlight Rebuild and press Enter to rebuild the array after you replace the
failed disk drive
For more information, see “Critical & Offline Disk Arrays” on page 289.
270
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting
WebPAM PROe Reports a Problem
WebPAM PROe aids in troubleshooting your logical drives and enclosure by
continuous monitoring and reporting to the User in the following ways:
•
Displays yellow !s
red Xs
in Tree View.
Figure 9. Yellow !s and red Xs in Tree View
•
Sends email messages, per your configuration.
•
Displays popup messages, per your configuration.
To set up email and popup message notification, see “Setting-up User Event
Subscriptions” on page 73.
Figure 10.An example of a popup message
•
Keeps a record in the Event Log.
271
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Figure 11. The Event Log
•
Keeps a record in the Event Log.
•
Displays full information in Management View.
Figure 12.A failed disk drive shown in Management View
Auto Rebuild
Replacement Drive
Failed Disk Drive
Critical / Rebuilding Status
272
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting
Also see these troubleshooting topics:
•
“Event Notification Response” on page 274
•
“Critical & Offline Disk Arrays” on page 289
•
“Frequently Asked Questions” on page 303
273
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Event Notification Response
When you select Event Notification, WebPAM PROe sends popup and/or email
messages regarding its status. The messages you see depend on your
notification selection and what is currently happening in the VTrak. See “Settingup User Event Subscriptions” on page 73.
The table below cites:
•
Reported Events – Events that require you to take action
•
Corrective Actions – The action you should take in response to the event
A list of event categories is shown below.
•
Battery (page 274)
•
Physical Disk (page 281)
•
Blowers (page 275)
•
•
Cache (page 276)
PSU (Power Supply Units)
(page 283)
•
Controller (page 276)
•
PSU Fans (page 283)
•
Disk Array (page 276)
•
RAID Level Migration (page 283)
•
Drive Interface Controller
(page 277)
•
Rebuild (page 284)
•
Redundancy Check (page 285)
•
Enclosure (page 277)
•
Resource (page 285)
•
Event Log (page 277)
•
Spare Check (page 285)
•
Fibre Channel (page 278)
•
Spare Drives (page 286)
•
Host Interface Controller
(page 278)
•
SMART (page 286)
•
Stripe Level Migration (page 286)
•
Logical Drive (page 279)
•
Synchronization (page 287)
•
Media Patrol (page 280)
•
System (VTrak) (page 287)
•
Online Capacity Expansion
(page 280)
•
Transition (page 287)
•
Watermark (page 288)
•
PDM (page 281)
Reported Event
Corrective Action
Battery
Battery temperature is
above the threshold
The battery is too hot. Verify proper airflow around
the through the VTrak. If airflow is OK, replace the
battery. See page 224.
Battery temperature is
normal
Normal.
Battery capacity is below
the threshold
Battery is drained. Run battery reconditioning. See
page 114 or page 160.
274
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting
Reported Event
Corrective Action
Battery capacity is normal Normal.
Battery is discharging
Battery is undergoing reconditioning.
Battery is charging
Battery is being recharged.
Battery reconditioning is
complete
Battery reconditioning is finished.
Battery is malfunctioning
Run battery reconditioning. See page 114 or
page 160. If this message reappears, replace the
battery.
Battery reconditioned
successfully
Battery reconditioning is finished.
Battery reconditioning has Replace the battery. See page 224.
failed
Battery is reaching end of Replace the battery. See page 224.
life
Battery is removed
The battery was disconnected or removed. Reinstall
the battery. See page 224.
Battery charging failed
Replace the battery. See page 224.
Battery reconditioning
started
Battery reconditioning has begun.
Battery recondition
terminated
The battery was disconnected or removed during
reconditioning. Reinstall the battery. See page 224.
Blowers
Blowers have started
Normal.
Blowers have stopped
Verify that the cooling unit is properly installed. If the
blower still does not turn, replace the blowers. See
page 219.
Blower speed is
increased
Check the VTrak for overheating. See page 295.
Blower speed is
decreased
Temporary overheat condition was corrected.
Blowers are NOT
functioning
Replace the blowers. See page 219.
Blowers have been
inserted
Normal.
275
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Reported Event
Corrective Action
Blowers have been
removed
Reinstall the cooling unit(s). If the blowers does not
turn, replace the blowers. See page 219.
Blowers are functioning
normally
Normal.
Blowers are NOT installed Reinstall the cooling unit(s). If the blowers does not
turn, replace the blowers. See page 219.
Blower status is unknown Check for airflow out of the cooling unit. If there is
none, check for proper installation.
Cache
BBU flushing has started
VTrak’s cache is being flushed.
BBU flushing has ended
VTrak’s cache has been flushed.
BBU flushing has failed
VTrak’s cache could not be flushed. Check your
cache flush interval setting. See page 107.
Controller
The controller
The user successfully change controller settings. See
parameter(s) changed by page 107.
user
The controller has new
crash information
Check the event logs. See page 63.
Controller temperature is
above the threshold/
warning threshold
The VTrak controller is overheating. Check for airflow
around and through the controller, and verify that all
fans are working. Replace fans as needed.
Controller temperature is
above the critical
threshold
The VTrak controller is seriously overheating. Check
for airflow around and through the controller, and
verify that all fans are working. Replace fans as
needed.
Disk Array
New disk array has been
created
Result of settings or user action. Normal.
Disk array has been
deleted
Result of settings or user action. Normal.
Disk array has been
added
Result of settings or user action. Normal.
Disk array has been
removed
The physical drives of the disk array were removed
from the enclosure.
276
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting
Reported Event
Disk array settings have
been changed
Corrective Action
The user successfully logical drive settings. See
page 127.
Drive Interface Controller
Drive-interface controller
found
Normal.
Drive-interface controller
is NOT found
Restart the VTrak. See page 215. If this message
appears repeatedly, contact Technical Support. See
page 305.
Drive-interface
diagnostics has passed
Normal.
Drive-interface
diagnostics has failed
Restart the VTrak. See page 215. If this message
appears repeatedly, contact Technical Support. See
page 305.
Drive-interface controller Drive-to-controller parity error. If this message
has generated a general/ appears repeatedly, contact Technical Support. See
data parity error.
page 305.
Enclosure
Enclosure temperature is The VTrak is overheating. Check for airflow around
above the threshold/
and through the VTrak, and verify that all fans are
warning threshold
working. Replace fans as needed.
Enclosure temperature is The VTrak is seriously overheating. Check for airflow
above the critical
around and through the VTrak, and verify that all fans
threshold
are working. Replace fans as needed.
Enclosure temperature is Normal.
within the normal range
Event Log
Event logging is enabled
Event logging has been successfully enabled.
Event logging is disabled Event logging has been disabled.
Event log buffer is cleared The event log was cleared.
in RAM
Event log buffer is cleared The non-volatile RAM event log was cleared.
in NVRAM
Event log buffer is cleared The MDD (disk drive) event log was cleared.
in MDD
277
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Reported Event
Corrective Action
Fibre Channel
Fibre Channel controller
has detected bus reset
The initiator sent a reset command. If this message
appears repeatedly, contact Technical Support. See
page 305.
Fibre Channel controller Result of user action. Normal.
has received a LUN reset
command.
Fibre Channel controller
has encountered a fatal
error
Restart the VTrak. See page 215. If this message
appears repeatedly, contact Technical Support. See
page 305.
Fibre Channel link is up
FC link connected and ready. Normal.
Fibre Channel link is
down
FC link disconnected or otherwise not working.
Fibre Channel controller
settings have changed
Result of user action. Normal.
Host Interface Controller
Host-interface controller
has detected bus reset
The initiator sent a reset command. If this message
appears repeatedly, contact Technical Support. See
page 305.
Host-interface controller
has encountered an
unrecoverable error
Restart the VTrak. See page 215.
Host-interface controller
has received an aborttask/ abort task set/clear
task set command.
Result of user action. Normal.
Host-interface controller
has received an clear
ACA command.
Result of clearing an auto contingent alliance
condition. If this message appears repeatedly,
contact Technical Support. See page 305.
Host-interface controller Result of user action. Normal.
has received a LUN reset
command.
Host-interface controller The VTrak rebooted itself. If this message appears
has received a bus reboot repeatedly, contact Technical Support. See page 305.
Host-interface controller
has encountered an
unknown error
An unidentified error occurred. If this message
appears repeatedly, contact Technical Support. See
page 305.
278
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting
Reported Event
Corrective Action
Host-interface controller
has encountered a
system error
A VTrak system error occurred. If this message
appears repeatedly, contact Technical Support. See
page 305.
Host-interface controller
has encountered a fatal
error
Restart the VTrak. See page 215. If this message
appears repeatedly, contact Technical Support. See
page 305.
Host-interface controller
settings have changed
Result of user action. Normal.
Logical Drive
Logical drive initialization Result of user action. Normal.
has started
Logical drive initialization Logical drive is ready to use. Normal.
has completed
Logical drive initialization Initialization paused because of user intervention,
has paused
schedule or a higher priority background activity.
Logical drive initialization Initialization has resumed again after a pause.
has resumed
Logical drive initialization Initialization stopped because of user intervention,
has stopped
schedule or the logical drive was deleted or went
critical or offline.
Logical drive initialization Initialization failure due to a failed disk drive. Replace
marks the logical drive
the disk drive, delete and recreate the logical drive.
offline
See page 17 and page 127.
Logical drive initialization System resources are low. Reduce system load or
is aborted due to an
restart the VTrak. See page 215.
internal error.
Logical drive initialization Initialization has been set manually or by schedule.
is queued
A new logical drive has
been created
Result of user action. Normal.
Logical drive has been
deleted
Result of user action. Normal.
Logical drive has been
placed online
The physical drives of the array are restored to online
status.
Logical drive has been
placed online. Possible
data loss
One or more physical drives in the array went offline.
See page 289.
279
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Reported Event
Corrective Action
Logical drive has been set One or more physical drives in the array went offline.
to critical.
See page 289.
Logical drive axle has
been placed online
RAID 50. One of the axles (RAID 5 arrays) returned
on online status.
Media Patrol
Media patrol is started
Result of settings or user action. Normal.
Media patrol is completed Normal.
Media patrol is paused
Media patrol paused because of user intervention,
schedule or a higher priority background activity.
Media patrol is resumed
Media patrol has resumed again after a pause.
Media patrol is stopped
Media patrol stopped because of user intervention,
schedule or the logical drive was deleted or went
critical or offline.
Media patrol is aborted
due to an internal error.
System resources are low. Reduce system load or
restart the VTrak. See page 215.
Media patrol is queued
Media patrol has been set manually or by schedule.
Media patrol is stopped
internally
Media patrol stopped because the disk array was
deleted or removed.
Online Capacity Expansion
Online capacity
expansion has started
Result of settings or user action. Normal.
Online capacity
Normal.
expansion has completed
Online capacity
expansion has paused
Expansion paused because of user intervention,
schedule or higher priority background activity.
Online capacity
expansion has resumed
Expansion has resumed again after a pause or a
reboot.
Online capacity
expansion has stopped
Expansion stopped because of user intervention,
schedule or the logical drive was deleted or went
critical or offline.
Online capacity
expansion has
encountered a physical
disk error
Bad block found on a disk drive. Migration will finish.
Check the disk drive check table after migration and
replace disk drive as needed. See page 138.
280
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting
Reported Event
Corrective Action
Online capacity
System resources are low. Reduce system load or
expansion is aborted due restart the VTrak. See page 215.
to an internal error.
Online capacity
expansion is queued
Synchronization has been set manually or by
schedule.
PDM
PDM is started
Result of settings or user action. Normal.
PDM is completed
Normal.
PDM is paused
PDM paused because of user intervention, schedule
or a higher priority background activity.
PDM is resumed
PDM has resumed again after a pause.
PDM is stopped
PDM stopped because of user intervention, schedule
or the logical drive was deleted or went critical or
offline.
PDM is switched to
rebuild.
PDM changed to rebuild because the logical drive
went critical
PDM is stopped internally The destination drive was removed or used for a
rebuild.
Physical Disk
Physical disk is marked
online
Disk drive restored to normal operation.
Physical disk is marked
online
Disk drive removed from service due to errors. If
necessary, try to force the disk online. See page 119
or page 164.
Physical disk is marked
as dead.
Disk drive failure. Replace the disk drive. See
page 17.
Physical disk has been
reset
Disk drive reset after error and should function
normally.
Physical disk assigned as Result of settings or user action. Normal.
global spare
Physical disk is no longer Result of settings or user action. Normal.
assigned as global spare
Physical disk assigned as Result of settings or user action. Normal.
dedicated spare
281
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Reported Event
Corrective Action
Physical disk is no longer Result of settings or user action. Normal.
assigned as dedicated
spare
Physical disk has been
inserted
A disk drive has been inserted into the VTrak
subsystem.
Physical disk has been
removed
A disk drive has been removed from the VTrak
subsystem.
Bad sector is found on
physical disk
Disk drive has a bad sector. The drive should remap
around the bad sector. If this message appears
repeatedly, replace the disk drive.
Error is detected in remap Disk drive has a bad remap sectors. If this message
sectors
appears repeatedly, replace the disk drive.
Command times out on
physical drive
Disk drive not responding to commands. If this
message appears repeatedly, replace the disk drive.
Physical disk negotiation
speed is decreased.
Disk drive had to reduce its data rate. If this message
appears repeatedly, replace the disk drive.
Previously configured disk Disk drive may have failed or was removed from the
is no longer found
enclosure. Replace or reinstall the disk drive as
needed.
A physical disk has
Disk drive experienced an unknown error. If this
encountered an unknown message appears repeatedly, replace the disk drive.
(non-ECC) media error.
A physical disk has
encountered PFA
condition
A potentially faulty address or bad sector was found.
A configured dead
physical drive has been
inserted
The disk drive inserted into the VTrak was marked as
dead and will not work on the VTrak. Replace the disk
drive.
A physical drive page 0/1 Result of settings or user action. Normal.
settings have been
changed
Physical disk is marked
as dead due to removal/
failure of reassign
sectors/PFA condition/
forced offline state
Replace the disk drive.
PSU (Power Supply Units)
282
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting
Reported Event
Corrective Action
PSU is not inserted/has
been removed
A power supply unit is missing from the VTrak.
Reinstall the power supply unit.
PSU is off
A power supply unit is present but turned off. Turn on
he power supply.
PSU is on
Normal.
Normal.
PSU is installed/
operational and turned on
PSU is installed/
A power supply unit is present but turned off. Turn on
operational and turned off he power supply.
PSU is malfunctioning
and turned on/off
Replace the power supply unit.
PSU 12V/5V/3.3V power
is out of the threshold
range
Replace the power supply unit.
PSU 12V/5V/3.3V power
is within the range
Normal.
PSU Fans
PSU fan has turned on.
Normal.
PSU fan has turned off.
Verify that the power supply is turned on. If the fan
still does not turn, replace the power supply. See
page 218.
PSU fan speed increased. Check the VTrak for overheating. See page 295.
PSU fan speed
decreased.
Temporary overheat condition was corrected.
PSU fan is malfunctioning Replace the power supply. See page 218.
PSU fan is functioning
normally
Normal.
PSU fan status is
unknown.
Check for airflow out of the power supply. If there is
none, check for proper installation and turn the power
supply on.
RAID Level Migration
RAID Level migration is
started
Result of settings or user action. Normal.
RAID Level migration is
completed
Normal.
283
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Reported Event
Corrective Action
RAID Level migration is
paused
Migration paused because of user intervention,
schedule or a higher priority background activity.
RAID Level migration is
resumed
Migration has resumed again after a pause.
RAID Level migration is
stopped
Migration stopped because of user intervention,
schedule or the logical drive was deleted or went
critical or offline.
RAID Level migration has Bad block found on a disk drive. Migration will finish.
encountered a physical
Check the disk drive check table after migration and
disk error
replace disk drive as needed. See page 138.
RAID Level migration is
System resources are low. Reduce system load or
aborted due to an internal restart the VTrak. See page 215.
error.
RAID Level migration is
queued
Migration has been set manually or by schedule.
Migration has detected/
cleared stale NV
Watermark
Watermarks are progress markers left as the result of
interrupted RAID migrations. If the watermark was
cleared, migration should finish.
Array was incomplete due RAID migration was interrupted by a shutdown. If
to missing NV Watermark array is online, try migration again. See page 129. If
array is offline, delete and recreate array. See
page 125 and page 123.
Rebuild
Rebuild is started
Result of settings or user action. Normal.
Rebuild is completed
Normal.
Rebuild is paused
Rebuild paused because of user intervention,
schedule or a higher priority background activity.
Rebuild is resumed
Rebuild has resumed again after a pause.
Rebuild is stopped
Rebuild stopped because of user intervention,
schedule or the logical drive was deleted or the target
disk drive encountered an error. If rebuild stopped by
user intervention, restart the rebuild. See page 130.
Rebuild stopped internally The logical drive is offline. See page 289.
Rebuild is aborted due to System resources are low. Reduce system load or
an internal error.
restart the VTrak. See page 215.
Rebuild is queued
Rebuild has been set manually or by schedule.
284
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting
Reported Event
Rebuild marks logical
drive synchronized upon
rebuild completion
Corrective Action
Result of successful rebuild. Normal.
Redundancy Check
Redundancy Check is
started
Redundancy Check has started manually or by
schedule.
Redundancy Check is
completed
Redundancy Check has finished.
Redundancy Check is
paused
Redundancy Check paused because of user
intervention, schedule or a higher priority background
activity.
Redundancy Check is
resumed
Redundancy Check has resumed again after a
pause.
Redundancy Check is
stopped
Redundancy Check stopped because of user
intervention, schedule or the logical drive was deleted
or went critical or offline.
Redundancy Check is
aborted due to internal
error
System resources are low. Reduce system load or
restart the VTrak. See page 215.
Redundancy Check
Check the logical drive’s inconsistent block table. See
encountered inconsistent page 138. Rebuild the disk array if necessary.
block(s)
page 130.
Redundancy Check task
is queued
Redundancy Check has been set manually or by
schedule.
Redundancy Check task
is stopped internally
The logical drive is offline. See page 289.
Resource
Resource is NOT
available
System resources are low. Reduce system load or
restart the VTrak. See page 215.
Spare Check
Spare check started on
the given spare drive
Result of settings or user action. Normal.
285
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Reported Event
Corrective Action
Spare check completed
Normal.
successfully on the given
spare drive
Spare Drives
Physical disk assigned as Result of settings or user action. Normal.
global spare
Physical disk is no longer Result of settings or user action. Normal.
assigned as global spare
Global Spare has been
deleted
Result of settings or user action. Normal.
Physical disk assigned as Result of settings or user action. Normal.
dedicated spare
Physical disk is no longer Result of settings or user action. Normal.
assigned as dedicated
spare
Dedicated Spare has
been deleted
Result of settings or user action. Normal.
SMART
SMART error is received
A disk drive reported a SMART error. If this message
appears repeatedly, replace the disk drive.
Stripe Level Migration
Stripe Level migration is
started
Result of settings or user action. Normal.
Stripe Level migration is
completed
Normal.
Stripe Level migration is
paused
Migration paused because of user intervention,
schedule or a higher priority background activity.
Stripe Level migration is
resumed
Migration has resumed again after a pause.
Stripe Level migration is
stopped
Migration stopped because of user intervention,
schedule or the logical drive was deleted or went
critical or offline.
Stripe Level migration has Bad block found on a disk drive. Migration will finish.
encountered a physical
Check the disk drive check table after migration and
disk error
replace disk drive as needed. See page 138.
286
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting
Reported Event
Corrective Action
Stripe Level migration is System resources are low. Reduce system load or
aborted due to an internal restart the VTrak. See page 215.
error.
Stripe Level migration is
queued
Migration has been set manually or by schedule.
Synchronization
Synchronization is started Result of settings or user action. Normal.
Synchronization is
completed
Normal.
Synchronization is
paused
Synchronization paused because of user
intervention, schedule or higher priority background
activity.
Synchronization is
resumed
Synchronization has resumed again after a pause or
a reboot.
Synchronization is
stopped
Synchronization stopped because of user
intervention, schedule or the logical drive was deleted
or went critical or offline.
Synchronization is
System resources are low. Reduce system load or
aborted due to an internal restart the VTrak. See page 215.
error.
Synchronization is
queued
Synchronization is already running on another logical
drive in the same array.
Synchronization is
stopped internally
Synchronization stopped because the disk array was
deleted or removed.
System (VTrak)
The system is started
The VTrak has been started.
The system is stopped
The VTrak was shut down.
Transition
Transition is started
Result of settings or user action. Normal.
Transition is completed
Normal.
Transition is paused
Transition paused because of user intervention,
schedule or a higher priority background activity.
Transition is resumed
Transition has resumed again after a pause.
Transition is stopped
Transition stopped because of user intervention or
the logical drive was deleted.
287
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Reported Event
Transition was switched
to rebuild
Corrective Action
Transition changed to rebuild because the logical
drive went critical.
Watermark
Migration has detected/
cleared stale NV
Watermark
Watermarks are progress markers left as the result of
interrupted RAID migrations. If the watermark was
cleared, migration should finish.
Array was incomplete due RAID migration was interrupted by a shutdown. If
to missing NV Watermark array is online, try migration again. See page 129. If
array is offline, delete and recreate array. See
page 125 and page 123.
288
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting
Critical & Offline Disk Arrays
A fault-tolerant disk array—RAID 1, 1E, 5, 10, and 50—goes critical when a disk
drive is removed or fails. A RAID 6 or 60 disk array—goes degraded when a disk
drive is removed or fails and critical when two disk drives are removed of fail.
Due to the fault tolerance of the disk array, the data is still available and online.
However, once the disk array goes critical, the disk array has lost its fault
tolerance, and performance may be adversely affected.
If the fault was caused by a failed drive that was removed, the drive must be
replaced by another drive, either identical or larger, in order for the RAID system
to rebuild and restore optimal configuration.
If your fault-tolerant disk array—RAID 1, 1E, 5, 6, 10, 50, and 60— goes offline,
contact Promise Technical Support. See “Contacting Technical Support” on
page 305.
Warning
Take no further corrective action until you have consulted with
Promise Technical Support.
A non-fault tolerant disk array—RAID 0—goes offline when a disk drive is
removed or fails. Since the disk array is not fault tolerant, the data stored in the
disk array is no longer accessible.
If one disk drive fails, all of the data on the disk array is lost. You must replace the
failed drive. Then, if the disk array had more than one disk drive, delete the disk
array and re-create it. Restore the data from a backup source.
When a Physical Drive Fails
VTrak provides both audible and visual indicators to alert you of a disk drive
failure. The following will occur when a disk drive fails or goes offline:
•
The Logical Drive LED changes from green to amber. See page 263.
•
The Disk Carrier Status LED changes from green to red. See page 264.
•
The audible alarm repeatedly sounds two short beeps. See page 262.
•
WebPAM PROe reports the condition. See page 271.
Also see “Physical Drive Problems” on page 293.
With a Hot Spare Drive
When a physical drive in a disk array fails and a spare drive of adequate capacity
is available, the disk array will begin to rebuild automatically using the spare
drive.
289
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
After the disk array rebuilds itself using the spare drive, you must replace the
failed drive.
To set up a spare drive, see “Creating a Spare Drive” on page 142 (WebPAM
PROe) or page 190 (CLU).
Without a Hot Spare Drive
If there is no hot spare drive of adequate capacity, you must remove the failed
drive and install an unconfigured replacement drive of the same or greater
capacity in the same slot as the failed drive. Until you install the replacement
drive, the logical drive will remain Degraded.
•
If the Auto Rebuild function is ENABLED, the disk array will begin to rebuild
automatically as soon as you replace the failed drive.
•
If the Auto Rebuild function is DISABLED, you must manually rebuild the
disk array after you replace the failed drive.
To enable Automatic Rebuild, see “Making Background Activity Settings” on
page 66 (WebPAM PROe) or page 186 (CLU).
To set Hot Spare Policy, see “Making Spare Drive Settings” on page 143
(WebPAM PROe) or page 191 (CLU).
Important
If your replacement disk drive was formerly part of a different disk
array or logical drive, you must clear the configuration data on the
replacement drive before you use it.
See “Clearing Stale and PFA Conditions” on page 119 (WebPAM
PROe) or page 163 (CLU).
Rebuild Operation
During rebuild:
•
The alarm sounds a single short beep, repeated
•
No warning icon displays over the Disk Array or Logical Drive in the Tree.
Management View reports the Disk Array’s Operational Status as OK,
Rebuilding.
•
The drive carrier holding the rebuilding physical drive displays a green
Activity (lower) LED while the Status (upper) LED flashes green once per
second.
290
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting
Figure 13.Drive carrier LEDs
Status
Activity
During rebuilding, you can still read and write data to the logical drive. However,
fault tolerance is lost until the Disk Array returns to OK (not-rebuilding) status.
After a successful rebuild:
•
The alarm is silent
•
The Disk Array’s Operational Status as OK
•
The rebuilt disk drive Status LED displays steady green
291
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Incomplete Array
An incomplete array can result from any of the following conditions:
•
The NVRAM watermark for the RAID level migration currently in progress is
missing or cannot be found
•
A physical drive goes missing during transport
See “Physical Drive Failed” on page 293 for more information.
When VTrak discovers an incomplete array, WebPAM PROe displays a dialog
box asking you to:
•
Click the OK button to accept the incomplete array
•
Click the Cancel button to reject the incomplete array
Before you accept the incomplete array, be sure all of the physical drives are
present and that their drive carriers are properly installed into the enclosure. See
“Installing Disk Drives” on page 18.
If you choose to accept the incomplete array:
1.
Click OK in the incomplete array dialog box.
2.
Check the operational status of the logical drives in the array.
3.
•
If the logical drives are critical or degraded, proceed with a rebuild.
See “Rebuilding a Disk Array” on page 130 or page 172.
•
If the logical drives are offline, contact Technical Support.
See “Contacting Technical Support” on page 305
Restore your data from a backup source, if required.
The CLU displays the option Accept Incomplete Array on the Disk Array Info and
Settings screen. Highlight the option and press Enter to accept the incomplete
array.
If you choose NOT to accept the incomplete array:
1.
Click Cancel in the incomplete array dialog box.
2.
Do one of the following:
•
Delete the array. See “Deleting a Disk Array” on page 125 or page 169.
•
Replace the missing physical drive.
292
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting
Physical Drive Problems
Physical Drive Offline
Check the drive for:
•
PFA Condition – Caused by a bad block or sector.
See “Clearing Stale and PFA Conditions” on page 119.
•
Stale Configuration – Caused by obsolete array information on the physical
drive. Identify the disk array to which the physical drive belongs. Then delete
the disk array. See “Deleting a Disk Array” on page 125.
If the error condition remains on the physical drive, clear the error condition.
See “Clearing Stale and PFA Conditions” on page 119.
Physical Drive Not Usable
This condition occurs when you have:
•
Two controllers in your VTrak subsystem and a SATA drive without an
AAMUX adapter. See “AAMUX Adapter” on page 18.
•
A missing or defective SAS cable between the VTrak subsystem and a
JBOD enclosure.
Physical Drive Failed
When physical drive status shows failed, the physical drive cannot be repaired.
You must replace the failed drive.
Physical Drive Fails during Migration
VTrak has two methods for migrating a disk array:
•
DDF – The default setting. Slower but reliable
•
NVRAM – An optional setting that requires special access. Faster but risks
data loss
Normally, RAID level migration is done under the default Disk Data Format (DDF)
setting. If a physical drive or the controller fails during migration, the disk array
goes critical, and you can rebuild it. Migration under DDF can take up to several
hours depending on the number and size of the physical drives and data input/
output activity.
You can set the VTrak to migrate disk arrays under Non-Volatile Random Access
Memory (NVRAM), a much faster process because it writes data to the memory
in the controller. However, if a physical drive or the controller fails during
migration, the logical drives will go offline and you will lose data. See “Incomplete
Array” on page 292.
293
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Because the setting for migration under NVRAM requires special access, most
users will not encounter this condition.
Physical Drive Fails during Transport
Transport is the action of moving the physical drives of a disk array:
•
To different slots in the same VTrak enclosure
•
From one VTrak enclosure to another
If a physical drive fails during a transport, or you do not move all of the physical
drives to their new locations, WebPAM PROe will display an incomplete array.
See “Incomplete Array” on page 292.
294
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting
Enclosure Problems
WebPAM PROe displays yellow !s
components that need attention.
red Xs
in Tree View to identify
When a yellow ! appears over a Subsystem
in Tree View, click on the
Enclosure
icon. The Enclosure screen will display (below).
Figure 14.Enclosure information in Management View
In this example, a power supply has failed. The Enclosure Diagram displays color
and motion changes to identify the failed power supply. In this case, you must
replace the power supply.
Note that the image above was shortened to fit on the page.
295
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Overheating
Overheating is a potentially serious condition because the
excessively high temperatures can lead to disk drive failure and
controller malfunction.
Overheating usually results from:
•
Fan failure
•
Poor air circulation around the enclosure
WebPAM PROe reports failed fans along with elevated
temperature. On VTrak, there are two kinds of fans:
•
Power supply, 2 fans each
•
Cooling units, 1 fan each
If a power supply fan fails, you must replace the power supply. If
a cooling unit fan fails, you can remove the cooling unit and
replace only the fan itself.
No tools are required for either procedure. See page 219 for
instructions on replacing the fans.
Air circulation around the VTrak enclosure may be a more
complex problem. Use the thermometer icons to help you locate
the specific hot spot. Check for these conditions:
•
Accumulated dust or objects blocking the fans
•
Less than a minimum of 5 inches (13 cm) space between the
back of the VTrak and the wall or other object
•
Ambient temperature above 95°F (35°C) where the VTrak is
operating
To cool down a VTrak:
•
Correct any problems identified above
•
Power it down and let it sit for an hour or longer
296
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting
Power Supplies
VTraks are equipped with redundant power supplies. The
advantage of dual power supplies is that, should one fail, the
other will continue powering the subsystem until the faulty one
can be replaced. VTrak is capable of operating on a single power
supply. As a result, if one power supply fails you must watch the
front panel LEDs or WebPAM PROe in order to become aware of
the condition.
The power supplies are hot-swappable, meaning you can leave
the VTrak running when you replace the bad one. Be careful,
however, to remove the faulty power supply and not the good
one, or VTrak will come to an immediate stop and your data will
be unavailable until the system is powered and booted again.
As noted above, if a power supply fan fails, you must replace the
power supply. Without the fan to cool it, the power supply will
overheat and eventually fail anyway.
No tools are required for the procedure. See your page 218 for
instructions on replacing a power supply.
Battery
VTrak uses a battery as backup power for the cache. Should a
power failure occur, the battery enables the cache to hold data up
to 72 hours. The battery recharges during normal VTrak
operation.
In most cases, installing a replacement battery will correct a
marginal or failed condition. The battery is located in the cooling
unit above the controller. Remove the cooling unit for access. The
battery is hot-swappable.
No tools are required for the procedure. See page 224 for
instructions on replacing the battery.
Also see “Reconditioning a Battery” on page 114 or page 161.
297
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Controller Enters Maintenance Mode
When a RAID controller encounters and internal problem, it can enter
maintenance mode. Maintenance mode is only for remedial action in the event of
a problem with the controller.
When an controller enters maintenance mode, it goes offline and it will display
Missing under Readiness Status.
Note that VTrak subsystems with only one controller will always show that the
second controller is “Missing.” For VTraks with two controllers, one of the
controllers will enter maintenance mode for any of the following reasons:
•
The “missing” controller is improperly connected
•
The “missing” controller was removed from the subsystem
•
One controller has different hardware compared to the other
•
One controller is Fibre Channel and the other is SAS
•
Each controller has a different size of memory
•
Each controller sees a different set of configured drives
•
Each controller is running a different version of firmware
To obtain this information for a controller, click on the Controller
icon,
Information tab, and look for Firmware Version and Memory Size.
To access the controller, use a serial connection. If you know the controller’s IP
address, you can access the controller using a Telnet connection.
To log into the VTrak CLI:
1.
2.
Change your terminal emulation program settings to match the following
specifications:
•
Bits per second: 115200
•
Data bits: 8
•
Parity: None
•
Stop bits: 1
•
Flow control: none
Start your PC’s terminal VT100 or ANSI emulation program.
3.
Press Enter once to launch the CLI.
4.
At the Login prompt, type administrator and press Enter.
5.
At the Password prompt, type password and press Enter.
6.
At the administrator@cli> prompt, type ctrl and press Enter.
The controller status will display. The controller whose Readiness Status is
Missing is in maintenance mode.
298
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting
Connection Problems
When you install your Promise product following the instructions in the Quick
Start Guide and this Product Manual, you should have little trouble getting your
equipment to work the first time. But connection problems can arise that are not
the User's or Installer's fault. Every conceivable problem cannot be covered in
the documentation but some guidelines could be helpful.
Connection problems cause a majority of failures in almost any electrical system.
While the installation of the cables and components was correct, they don't
function properly, or at all, because:
•
A connector is dirty or corroded
•
A connector is loose or damaged
•
A cable looks OK outside but has an open circuit inside
•
The wrong cable was used
VTraks ship with a full set of new cables, as required for each specific model. Be
sure to use these components because: 1.) They are the proper ones for your
RAID subsystem, 2.) They are in brand-new condition, and 3.) You paid for them
with the purchase of your VTrak.
Serial Connections
VTrak uses a serial connection for the command line interface (CLI) and the
command line utility (CLU). After you set the IP address, you can access the CLI
and CLU through a network connection, also. Normally, users prefer WebPAM
PROe because of its graphic user interface. But the CLI and CLU can do the
same jobs. And they will work when your network connection is down.
For VTrak, you must use the CLI or CLU to set the Management Port IP address
in order for WebPAM PROe to connect with it. See “Setting up the Serial
Connection” on page 35. This issue is discussed further under Network
Connections (below). See the “Making Serial Cable Connections” on page 32 for
more information on making the connection.
The CLI and CLU control and manage but they do not move data. They
communicates through a null-modem cable, supplied with the VTrak. A straightthrough serial cable will not work for this purpose. You may choose not use the
CLI or CLU often and want to disconnect and store the cable. Consider leaving it
connected, to be sure it will be there when you need it.
Network Connections
Each controller has an Ethernet (RJ45) Management Port connector on the back
of the enclosure. This is a Gigabit Ethernet connector designed to connect to
299
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
your network. The VTrak becomes a node on your network like any other PC,
server or other component with an IP address.
VTrak ships from the factory an IP address of 10.0.0.2. You must change this
address to one that will work with your network. You make the initial IP address
setting using the CLI or CLU. See “Setting up the Serial Connection” on page 35.
Figure 15.Management port connection on the RAID controller
Connectivity LED
LEDs
Activity LED
Mgmt
State
Dark
Amber
Green
Connectivity
10BaseT
1000BaseT
100BaseT
Activity
No activity
Flashing Green
Activity
Note that VTrak Management Port can accept IP address assignments from a
DHCP server. Use VTrak’s Command Line Utility (CLU) to enable this feature. If
you have not activated DHCP support but there is a DHCP server on your
network, there is a chance that it will inadvertently assign the VTrak’s
Management Port IP address to another node. You might see a warning to this
effect on your PC's monitor. If this happens, WebPAM PROe may not be able to
connect. See your network administrator to work out a suitable arrangement.
Fibre Channel Connections
When there is a connection failure, use WebPAM PROe to verify that VTrak sees
the initiator(s). See “Viewing Fibre Channel Initiators” on page 82.
If VTrak sees some initiators but not the one you want, the problem is most likely
elsewhere in the loop or fabric. If VTrak does not see any initiators:
•
Check all of the Fibre Channel connections
•
Verify that all nodes are properly connected and powered
•
Verify that the fabric router or switch is properly connected powered
The Fibre Channel ports, transceivers, and controller on VTrak function the same
as comparable components on other nodes.
For more information, see “Managing Fibre Channel Connections” on page 79.
300
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting
Browser Does Not Connect to WebPAM PROe
If you successfully setup and connected to WebPAM PROe, then suddenly you
can no longer connect, it might be the result of the following three conditions:
•
DHCP is enabled on your VTrak’s virtual management port
•
The DHCP server does not have a dedicated IP address for the VTrak
•
The VTrak restarted and your DHCP server assigned a new IP address
You must obtain the new IP Address for the virtual management port in order to
direct your browser to the VTrak and start WebPAM PROe.
To access the new IP address:
1.
Start your PC’s terminal VT100 or ANSI emulation program.
2.
Press Enter once to launch the CLI.
3.
At the Login prompt, type administrator and press Enter.
4.
At the Password prompt, type password and press Enter.
5.
Type net and press Enter.
administrator@cli> net
===========================================
CId Port Type IP
Mask
Gateway
Link
===========================================
Virtual
Mgmt 192.168.10.85 255.255.255.0 192.168.10.1 Up
The new virtual management port IP address and other network settings
display.
6.
Enter the new IP address into your browser to log into WebPAM PROe.
For more information, see “Setting up the Serial Connection” on page 35 and
“Logging into WebPAM PROe” on page 42.
301
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Unsaved Data in the Controller Cache
An LED (marked with the
icon) is provided to inform you that there is data in
the cache that has not been saved to non-volatile memory. Such data is
sometimes called “dirty,” not to suggest it is corrupted in some way but because it
has not been saved to a disk drive.
Figure 16.The VTrak E610f/E310f dirty cache LED
Mgmt
FC 1
4
FC 2
2
UPS
4
2
1
1
Gb/s
Gb/s
115200
8N1
Dirty Cache LED
Figure 17.The VTrak E610s/E310s dirty cache LED
Mgmt
UPS
115200
8N1
Dirty Cache LED
If there is unsaved data in the controller’s cache, the Dirty Cache LED shines
amber. During this time, do NOT power down the VTrak. Wait until the LED will
goes dark.
302
Chapter 9: Support
This chapter covers the following topics:
•
Frequently Asked Questions (below)
•
Contacting Technical Support (page 305)
•
Limited Warranty (page 308)
•
Returning product for repair (page 309)
Frequently Asked Questions
What kind of disk drives can I use with VTrak?
VTrak supports 1.5 and 3.0 GB/s Serial ATA disk drives and 3.0 Gb/s SAS
drives.
Can I take the disk drives from my UltraTrak, put them into the VTrak and
keep my disk array or logical drive intact?
Yes. UltraTrak and early VTrak subsystems used a proprietary method of
disk metadata, stored in the reserve sector of each physical drive. VTrak
E-Class uses the industry-standard DDF and has a metadata-to-DDF
conversion feature. To use the conversion feature, you must restart the
VTrak after installing disk drives from an older system.
VTrak E-Class does not support Parallel ATA (PATA) disk drives.
Note that if you move the disk drives from the VTrak E610f/s or E310f/s to
the older subsystems, they will not recognize your disk array or logical drive.
How can I tell when the VTrak has fully booted?
When the VTrak is fully booted up, the Power and FRU LEDs will light up
green. If a disk array is present, the Logical Drive LED will light up green
also. The Controller heartbeat LED blinks once every two seconds.
Why does VTrak come with a Command Line Utility?
First, to assign your VTrak an IP address in order for the WebPAM
management software to connect to it. Second, in the event of a network
failure, you can still access the VTrak. Third, some users prefer the
Command Line Utility.
303
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
WebPAM connection was working OK. But later on, it timed out. What do I
do now?
The network condition can time-out for several reasons. When an open
connection has no action for a specific amount of time (the Administrator can
change it), the connection times-out automatically for security reasons.
When you attempt to use WebPAM, it returns to the login screen. Enter your
user name and password and click Login, and WebPAM will establish a new
connection. See “Making Web Server Settings” on page 91.
I can access the VTrak over my company’s intranet. But I can’t access it
from an outside Internet connection. How do I make the Internet connection
work?
This condition is not related to VTrak, but is due to your firewall and network
connection protocol. Contact your MIS Administrator.
With other Promise VTraks, I used the Server’s IP address in WebPAM to
connect with the RAID subsystem. Why is this VTrak E-Class different?
VTrak E-Class has the server software embedded. With the E-Class, you
point your browser directly to the VTrak rather than a server. Also, with
E-Class, you do not have to create a subsystem because the subsystem
already exists.
Why can a RAID 1 logical drive on VTrak consist of only two disk drives?
On VTrak, RAID 1 logical drives work in mirrored physical drive pairs. You
could create up to six RAID 1 logical drives. Or you can create a single RAID
10 logical drive with data mirroring and up to 12 physical drives. If you have
an odd number of drives but still want data mirroring, use RAID 1E.
See “Installing Disk Drives” on page 17 and “Introduction to RAID” on
page 231 for more information on the number of physical drives you can use
for each RAID level.
Are logical drives on VTrak limited to 2 TB?
No. But verify that your operating system supports logical drives over 2 TB.
Also, for the operating system to recognize the full capacity of logical drives
over 2 TB, you must specify a sector size of 1 KB or larger when you create
the logical drive. See “Choosing Sector Size” on page 245 or more
information.
I have two UltraTraks and use WebPAM to monitor them. Can I use my
existing WebPAM setup to monitor the VTraks also?
No. Use the WebPAM embedded with the VTrak E-Class.
304
Chapter 9: Support
How can I be sure everything is working OK on the VTrak?
Locally: The VTrak enclosure has LEDs on the front to monitor the status of
power, field replaceable units (FRUs) and logical drives. When these are
green, VTrak is functioning normally.
Remotely: Check the Tree Icons in WebPAM. If there are no yellow or red
warning icons displayed, VTrak is functioning normally.
What happens if a logical drive goes critical?
On the front of VTrak, the logical drive LED turns amber and an audible
alarm sounds. See “Critical & Offline Disk Arrays” on page 289.
Can VTrak run using just one power supply?
Yes, it is possible to run VTrak on a single power supply. There are two
power supplies so that VTrak will continue running if one of the power supply
fails. But deliberately leaving one power supply off negates this advantage.
In addition, leaving one power supply off reduces air flow through the VTrak
enclosure and can contribute to overheating. Always switch on both power
supplies.
Contacting Technical Support
Promise Technical Support provides several support options for Promise users to
access information and updates. We encourage you to use one of our electronic
services, which provide product information updates for the most efficient service
and support.
If you decide to contact us, please have the following information available:
•
Product model and serial number
•
BIOS, firmware, and driver version numbers
•
A description of the problem / situation
•
System configuration information, including: motherboard and CPU type,
hard drive model(s), SAS/SATA/ATA/ATAPI drives & devices, and other
controllers.
Technical Support Services
Promise Online™ Web Site
http://www.promise.com/support
(technical documents, drivers, utilities, etc.)
305
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
United States
E-mail Support
e-Support On-Line
Fax Support
(408) 228-1097 Attn: Technical Support
Phone Support
(408) 228-1400 option 4
If you wish to write us for
support:
Promise Technology, Inc.
580 Cottonwood Drive
Milpitas, CA 95035, USA
The Netherlands
E-mail Support
e-Support On-Line
Fax Support
+31 (0) 40 256 9463 Attn: Technical Support
Phone Support
+31 (0) 40 235 2600
If you wish to write us for
support:
Promise Technology Europe B.V.
Science Park Eindhoven 5542
5692 EL Son, The Netherlands
Germany
E-mail Support
e-Support On-Line
Fax Technical Support
+49 (0) 2 31 56 76 48 - 29
Attn: Technical Support
Phone Technical Support
+49 (0) 2 31 56 76 48 - 10
If you wish to write us for
support:
Promise Technology Germany
Europaplatz 9
44269 Dortmund, Germany
Italy
E-mail Support
e-Support On-Line
Fax Support
0039 06 367 12400 Attn: Technical Support
Phone Support
0039 06 367 12626
If you wish to write us for
support:
Promise Technology Italy
Piazza del Popolo 18
00187 Roma, Italia
306
Chapter 9: Support
Taiwan
E-mail Support
e-Support On-Line
Fax Support
+886 3 578 2390 Attn: Technical Support
Phone Support
+886 3 578 2395 (ext. 8811)
If you wish to write us for
support:
Promise Technology, Inc.
2F, No. 30, Industry E. Rd. IX
Science-based Industrial Park
Hsin-Chu 30075, Taiwan (R.O.C.)
China
E-mail Support
e-Support On-Line
Fax Support
+86-10-8857-8015 Attn: Technical Support
Phone Support
+86-10-8857-8085/8095
If you wish to write us for
support:
Promise Technology China
Room 1205, Tower C
Webok Time Center, No.17
South Zhong Guan Cun Street
Hai Dian District, Beijing 100081, China
307
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Limited Warranty
Promise Technology, Inc. (“Promise”) warrants that for three (3) years from the
time of the delivery of the product to the original end user:
a)
the product will conform to Promise’s specifications;
b)
the product will be free from defects in material and workmanship under
normal use and service.
This warranty:
a)
applies only to products which are new and in cartons on the date of
purchase;
b)
is not transferable;
c)
is valid only when accompanied by a copy of the original purchase
invoice.
d)
Is not valid on spare parts, fans, and power supplies
This warranty shall not apply to defects resulting from:
a)
improper or inadequate maintenance, or unauthorized modification(s),
performed by the end user;
b)
operation outside the environmental specifications for the product;
c)
accident, misuse, negligence, misapplication, abuse, natural or
personal disaster, or maintenance by anyone other than a Promise or a
Promise-authorized service center.
Disclaimer of other warranties
This warranty covers only parts and labor, and excludes coverage on software
items as expressly set above.
Except as expressly set forth above, Promise DISCLAIMS any warranties,
expressed or implied, by statute or otherwise, regarding the product, including,
without limitation, any warranties for fitness for any purpose, quality,
merchantability, non-infringement, or otherwise. Promise makes no warranty or
representation concerning the suitability of any product for use with any other
item. You assume full responsibility for selecting products and for ensuring that
the products selected are compatible and appropriate for use with other goods
with which they will be used.
Promise DOES NOT WARRANT that any product is free from errors or that it will
interface without problems with your computer system. It is your responsibility to
back up or otherwise save important data before installing any product and
continue to back up your important data regularly.
308
Chapter 9: Support
No other document, statement or representation may be relied on to vary the
terms of this limited warranty.
Promise’s sole responsibility with respect to any product is to do one of the
following:
a)
replace the product with a conforming unit of the same or superior
product;
b)
repair the product.
Promise shall not be liable for the cost of procuring substitute goods, services,
lost profits, unrealized savings, equipment damage, costs of recovering,
reprogramming, or reproducing of programs or data stored in or used with the
products, or for any other general, special, consequential, indirect, incidental, or
punitive damages, whether in contract, tort, or otherwise, notwithstanding the
failure of the essential purpose of the foregoing remedy and regardless of
whether Promise has been advised of the possibility of such damages. Promise
is not an insurer. If you desire insurance against such damage, you must obtain
insurance from another party.
Some states do not allow the exclusion or limitation of incidental or consequential
damages for consumer products, so the above limitation may not apply to you.
This warranty gives specific legal rights, and you may also have other rights that
vary from state to state. This limited warranty is governed by the State of
California.
Your Responsibilities
You are responsible for determining whether the product is appropriate for your
use and will interface with your equipment without malfunction or damage. You
are also responsible for backing up your data before installing any product and
for regularly backing up your data after installing the product. Promise is not
liable for any damage to equipment or data loss resulting from the use of any
product.
Returning Product For Repair
If you suspect a product is not working properly, or if you have any questions
about your product, contact our Technical Support Staff through one of our
Technical Services, making sure to provide the following information:
•
Product model and serial number (required)
•
Return shipping address
•
Daytime phone number
•
Description of the problem
•
Copy of the original purchase invoice
309
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
The technician will assist you in determining whether the product requires repair.
If the product needs repair, the Technical Support Department will issue an RMA
(Return Merchandise Authorization) number.
Important
Obtain an RMA number from Technical Support before you return
the product and write the RMA number on the label. The RMA
number is essential for tracking your product and providing the
proper service.
Return ONLY the specific product covered by the warranty (do not ship cables,
manuals, diskettes, etc.), with a copy of your proof of purchase to:
USA and Canada:
Promise Technology, Inc.
Customer Service Dept.
Attn.: RMA # ______
47654 Kato Road
Fremont, CA 94538
Other Countries:
Return the product to your dealer
or retailer.
Contact them for instructions
before shipping the product.
You must follow the packaging guidelines for returning products:
•
Use the original shipping carton and packaging
•
Include a summary of the product’s problem(s)
•
Write an attention line on the box with the RMA number
•
Include a copy of proof of purchase
You are responsible for the cost of insurance and shipment of the product to
Promise. Note that damage incurred due to improper transport or packaging is
not covered under the Limited Warranty.
When repairing returned product(s), Promise may replace defective parts with
new or reconditioned parts, or replace the entire unit with a new or reconditioned
unit. In the event of a replacement, the replacement unit will be under warranty
for the remainder of the original warranty term from purchase date, or 30 days,
whichever is longer.
Promise will pay for standard return shipping charges only. You will be required
to pay for any additional shipping options (such as express shipping).
310
Appendix A: Useful Information
The appendix covers the following topics:
•
SNMP MIB Files (below)
•
Adding a Second Controller (page 311)
SNMP MIB Files
Promise supplies two MIB files to integrate the VTrak E610f/s or E310f/s
subsystem into your SNMP system. These files are in the SNMP folder on the
VTrak Product CD.
The MIB files are:
•
FCMGMT-MIB.mib
•
raidv4.mib
For help loading the MIB files, see the instructions that came with your MIB
browser.
Adding a Second Controller
If your VTrak E-Class subsystem shipped with one controller, you can add a
second controller. The second controller must have:
•
The same Firmware version as the currently installed controller
•
The same amount of SDRAM as the currently installed controller
To obtain this information for the currently installed controller, click on the
Controller
icon, Information tab, and look for Firmware Version and Memory
Size.
Obtain your second controller though Promise Technology. Promise Support will
prepare the new controller with Firmware and SDRAM to match your current
VTrak subsystem.
When you order the second controller, you should also order a second cache
battery to power the new controller’s cache in the event of a power failure.
The VTrak subsystem boots its controllers sequentially. With a second controller
installed, your subsystem will take about a minute longer to boot. This condition
is normal.
Installing a Second Controller
To install a second controller in your VTrak subsystem:
1.
Shut down the subsystem.
311
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
2.
Remove the blank cover from the right controller slot.
3.
Carefully slide the new controller into the slot until the handle locks in place.
4.
Attach your data and management cables to the new controller, as needed.
See the “Making Management and Data Connections” on page 21 for cable
connection information.
5.
Power up the subsystem and launch WebPAM PROe.
6.
Click on the Controllers
in Management view.
7.
icon in the Tree, then look at the Information tab
•
If the controllers’ Operational Status is OK, the installation was
successful.
•
If one of the controller’s Operational Status is Missing, one of the
controllers went into maintenance mode. See page 298.
With the second controller successfully installed, make the following
settings:
•
Redundancy Type to Active-Active or Active-Standby. See page 62.
•
LUN Affinity if you choose Active-Active redundancy. See page 107.
Dual Controllers and SATA Drives
If your VTrak subsystem has SATA disk drives installed, you must install an
AAMUX adapter on each of the SATA drives.
Without the AAMUX adapter, SATA drives will display Not Usable under
Operational Status.
See the “Installing Disk Drives” on page 17 for installation instructions.
This condition does not apply to SAS disk drives.
Obtain AAMUX adapters though Promise Technology.
312
Appendix A: Useful Information
Installing a Second Cache Battery
The cache battery comes as an assembly, with attaching screws and a wiring
harness. Install the new cache battery into the cooling unit above the new
controller.
To install a new cache battery:
1.
On the cooling unit above the new controller, press the release button and
pull the handle downward.
2.
Pull the cooling unit out of the VTrak enclosure.
3.
Loosen the thumbscrews. A retainer keeps the thumbscrews in place.
4.
Grasp the top section near the thumbscrews and lift it off the bottom section.
5.
Place the battery assembly into the bottom section of the cooling unit as
shown in Figure 1 (E610f/s) or 2 (E310f/s).
6.
Install the two screws that came with the battery assembly as shown.
7.
Attach the wiring harness from the battery assembly to the circuit board in
the cooling unit as shown.
Figure 1. IE610f/s cache battery installation
Mounting screw
Attach this connector
313
Battery Assembly
Mounting screw
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
Figure 2. E310f/s cache battery installation
Mounting screw
Attach this connector
Battery Assembly
Mounting screw
8.
Place the top section of the cooling unit onto the bottom section and tighten
the thumbscrews.
9.
Carefully slide the cooling unit into the enclosure.
10. Gently press the handle in and upward until it locks.
314
Index
B
Numerics
10GB Truncate 108, 156, 251
2 TB Limitation 246, 304
background activities
deleting schedule 70
list of scheduled 68
running 67
scheduling 69
settings 66, 186
view 66
battery
checking 113, 160
failure 297
LED 267
reconditioning 114, 161
replace 224
reported events 274, 275
BBU, reported events 276
blower, reported events 275, 276
browser, does not connect 301
buzzer
settings 115, 212
silence 115
sounding 262, 289
test 115
A
AAMUX adapter 18, 312
about this manual 1
Active-Active 62, 152, 312
adaptive writeback cache 108, 156
adaptive writeback cache, defined
247
add
controller 311
LUN map 88, 194
alarm
cancel 115, 212
sounds 262, 289
alias
controller 107, 156
disk array 124, 127, 168, 174
logical drive 47, 124, 136, 168
physical drive 118, 163
subsystem 62, 152
architectural description 4
array incomplete, reported events
C
288
Cache Mirroring
defined 248
setting 62, 152
cancel alarm 115, 212
capacity coercion
defined 250
setting 108, 156
capacity, specify for logical drive
Auto Fix 69, 138, 178
Auto Rebuild
enable 67, 186
function 130, 290
axles
RAID 50 47, 124, 127,
168,
175, 238
RAID 60 47, 124, 127, 168,
175, 240
47, 124, 128, 168, 174
CE statement 9
certificate, security 49
change RAID level 129, 172,
check table, logical drive 138
315
252
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
CIM
service 96, 203
settings 95, 203
clear statistics 102, 207
clear tab, controller 108
CLU
log in 148
log out 150
main menu 149
online help 150
problem reporting 269
serial connection 148
Telnet connection 148
Command Line Interface (CLI) 35
Command Line Utility (CLU) 35,
controller, cont.
locate 105, 157
maintenance mode 298
management port settings 77
missing 298, 312
replace 228
reported events 276, 277,
278, 279
settings 107, 156
statistics 107
status LED 268
unsaved data in cache 302
view 105
cooling unit
LED 267
status 112, 159
counter-sink screws 18
create 44
disk array 121, 165, 249
logical drive 127
spare drive 142, 190
user 75, 196
critical
disk array 126, 170
logical drive 134
303
command queuing
physical drives 117, 162
configuration status, physical drive
117
connections
Fibre Channel 21
power 33
problems 299
SAS 26
connector
RJ45 21, 26, 299
SAS 24
serial 32
controller
adaptive writeback cache 108
adding second 311
alias 107, 156
cache flush interval 108, 156
check status in CLI 298
clear tab 108
dual controllers and SATA
drive 312
failover and failback 248
heartbeat LED 33, 263
information 106, 155
D
DAS
Fibre Channel 22
SAS 27
data connector
Fibre Channel 21
SAS 26
data port, SAS 26, 27
data/cascade port, SAS 26, 27
date and time, subsystem 37, 39,
63, 154
DB9 connector 32
dedicated spare drive 141,
142,
143, 190, 191, 251
default settings, restore 101, 208
316
Index
delete
disk array 125, 169
initiator 88, 194
logical drive 129, 175
spare drive 143
user 76, 198
deleting schedule, background activities 70
DHCP server changed IP address
disk array, cont.
transport 132, 171
transport ready 126, 170
view 121
disk drive
carrier 18
installing 17
disk status LED 34, 110, 264, 289,
290, 291
301
dirty cache LED 268
Discover button 60
disk array
advanced creation
168
DMA mode, SATA drives 117, 162
download firmware image file 213,
216
drive slot numbering
47, 123,
E
alias 124, 127, 168, 174
automatic creation 45, 122,
17
edit LUN map 89, 194
email
service 91, 199
settings 90, 199
test message 74, 90
email messages 271
enable LUN masking 88, 193
enclosure
information 112, 158
locate 110, 161
overheat 296
reported events 277
settings 112, 160
temperature 112, 159
topology 111, 161
view 110
voltage 112, 159
error block threshold 67, 187
event
notification response 274
severity 73, 96, 204
subscriptions 73
event log
clear 64, 66, 188, 189
NVRAM 188, 269
problem reporting 271
166
create 44, 121, 165, 249
critical 126, 170, 289
delete 125, 169
expand 172
expansion 254
express creation 46, 122, 167
incomplete array 171
information 126, 170
locate 174
manual rebuild 130
Media Patrol 131
migrate 129, 172
offline 289
operational status 126, 170
PDM 131, 173, 174
physical drive selection 47,
124, 168
rebuild 130, 172, 290
rebuilding 126, 170
reported events 276
settings 127, 170, 171
synchronizing 126, 170
transition 132
317
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
event log, cont.
reported events 277
runtime 63, 188, 269
save 64, 65
expand disk array 129, 172
expansion port, SAS 26
expansion ranges 254
export user database 98
firmware update
from PC 214
from TFTP server 213, 216
WebPAM PROe 213, 216
flush interval, controller cache 108,
156
force offline 119, 164
force online 119, 164
forced unlock 71
FRU
LED 33, 263
status LED 265
VPD 113, 158
full initialization 137, 177
F
failed
battery 297
physical drive 293
power supply 295, 297
power supply fan 296
failover and failback 248
LUN Affinity 250
failure recovery, physical drive 289
FCC statement 9
Features
highlights 5
operational 6
subsystem and controller 6
system management 7
Fibre Channel
connections 300
DAS 22
data connection 21
HBA 83
HBA card 21, 22, 24
initiator 82, 140, 183
logged-in devices 82, 181
node information 79, 181
port settings 79, 80, 181
port statistics 81, 182
reported events 278
SAN 21
switch 21, 22, 24, 83
topology 81, 182
firmware image file, download 213,
G
GB Truncate 108, 156, 251
global spare drive 141, 142,
190, 191
Group Rounding
143,
108, 156, 251
H
HBA card
Fibre Channel 21, 22
SAS 27, 28, 30
Head Unit 110
heartbeat LED 33, 263
hot spare drive 251, 289
I
import user database 99
incomplete array 171, 292
inconsistent block table 139
information
controller 106, 155
disk array 126, 170
enclosure 112, 158
Fibre Channel node 79, 181
FRU VPD 113, 158
logical drive 134, 145, 176
216
318
Index
information, cont.
physical drive 117, 163
SAS port settings 84, 184
subsystem 61
initialization
defined 251
rate 66, 187
initialize logical drive 137, 177
initiator
delete 88, 194
Fibre Channel 82, 140, 183
Fibre Channel, add 83, 87,
LED, cont.
controller status 105, 157, 268
cooling unit 267
dirty cache 105, 157, 268,
302
disk status 34, 110, 264, 289,
290, 291
Ethernet connector
fan 267
FRU 33, 303
263
FRU status 265
heartbeat 33, 263, 303
logical drive 33, 263, 289
power 33, 263, 303
power supply 267
power/activity 33, 264
red or amber 263
RJ45 connector 300
locate
controller 105, 157
disk array 174
enclosure 110, 161
logical drive 178
physical drive 116, 117, 164
power supply 112, 159
spare drive 141
lock
releasing 71, 154
renewing 71, 154
setting 70, 153
subsystem 70, 153
view status 70, 153
log in
CLI 35, 298, 301
CLU 148
WebPAM PROe 42, 52
log out
CLU 150
WebPAM PROe 48, 59
183, 193
SAS 85, 140, 185
SAS, add 86, 87, 185, 193
installing disk drives 17
Internet access to WebPAM PROe
49
intranet access to WebPAM PROe
304
IP address
DHCP or static 36
DHCP server changed 301
maintenance mode 37, 38, 40,
41, 78, 180
management port
52
300
37, 39, 42,
NetSend recipient 97, 205
virtual management port 179,
300, 301
J
JBOD expansion 24, 30, 112, 161
L
language selection, WebPAM
PROe 44, 54
LED
battery 267
controller 33, 263, 303
319
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
M
logged-in devices
Fibre Channel 82, 181
logical drive
alias 47, 124, 136, 168
capacity 47, 124, 128, 168,
MAC address 36
main menu, CLU 149
maintenance mode 37,
179, 298
174
management connection
Fibre Channel 21
SAS 26
management port, virtual 36
Media Patrol 131
defined 255
enable 47, 67, 124, 168, 171,
check table 138
create 127, 173
critical 134
delete 129, 175
information 134, 145, 176
initialize 137, 177
LED 33, 289
locate 178
LUN 139
offline 135
partition and format 252
RAID level 47, 124, 127, 168
rebuilding 134
Redundancy Check 137, 178
reported events 279, 280
settings 136, 176, 177, 250
status 134
Summary 145
synchronization 135
synchronizing 134
transport ready 135
view list of all 145
logout other users 76
LUN affinity 48, 107, 125, 136,
186
reported events 280
run 68, 153
schedule 69
MIB files 311
migrate
disk array 129, 172
rate 66, 186
reported events 283
missing controller 298
N
NetSend
recipients 96, 204
requirements 97, 205
service 97, 204
settings 96, 203
network interface card (NIC) 21,
156, 312
defined 249
LUN map
add 88, 194
edit 89
logical drive 139
view 88
LUN masking, enable 88,
40, 77,
22, 24, 27, 28, 30
network switch 21, 22, 24, 27, 28,
30
null-modem cable 32, 148
numbering drive slots 17
NVRAM event log 188, 269
193
O
offline
logical drive
320
135
Index
offline, cont.
physical drive 119, 164, 293
online capacity expansion 252
reported events 280, 281
online help
CLU 150
WebPAM PROe 56
operational status
disk array 126, 170
orphan watermark 108, 155
overheated enclosure 296
overview of VTrak 2
physical drive, cont.
information 117, 163
installing 17
list 116
locate 116, 117, 164
not usable 293
operational status 117
read cache 117, 162
reported events 281, 282
select for array 47, 124, 168
select for spare 142, 190
settings 118
stale and PFA condition 119,
163, 290, 293
P
statistics 118
supported 303
write cache 117, 162
popup messages 271
port settings
Fibre Channel 79, 80, 181
SAS 84, 184
port statistics
Fibre Channel 81, 182
SAS 85, 185
power
connection 33
LED 33, 263
power supply
failed 295, 297
fan failure 296
LED 267
locate 159
replace 218
reported events 283
status 112, 158
power supply fan reported events
partition and format 252
password
CLI/CLU 35, 148
CLU 197
WebPAM PROe 43, 52, 74
Pause On Error 69, 138, 178
PDM
defined 256
enable 47, 124, 168, 171
rate 67, 187
reported events 281
running 68, 131, 173
triggers 67, 187, 256
PFA condition 119, 163
physical drive
AAMUX 18
alias 118, 163
capacity coercion 108, 156,
250
command queuing 117, 162
configurational status 117
DMA mode 117, 162
failed 293
failure recovery 289
force offline or online 119, 164
from older subsystem 303
global settings 116, 162
283
power/activity LED 33, 264
Predictive Data Migration 256
preferred controller ID 48, 125,
128, 136, 168, 174
321
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
privileges
CLU user 197
WebPAM PROe user 75
problem reporting
CLU 269
WebPAM PROe 271, 289
Q
quick initialization
read cache, cont.
policy 48, 125, 128, 136, 168,
174
policy, defined 247
read check table 139
reassigned block threshold 67, 187
rebuild
disk array 130, 172, 290
manual 130
rate 66, 186
reported events 284
rebuilding
disk array 126, 170
logical drive 134
recipients, NetSend 96
recondition a battery 114, 161
red X 262, 271, 295
Redundancy Check 69, 137, 178
rate 66, 187
reported events 285
redundancy, subsystem 62, 152
regulatory statements 9
releasing lock 71, 154
renewing lock 71, 154
repair, returning product for 309
replace
battery 224
blower 219
controller 228
fan 219
power supply 218
reported events
array incomplete 288
battery 274, 275
BBU 276
blower 275, 276
controller 276, 277, 278, 279
disk array 276
enclosure 277
event log 277
Fibre Channel 278
177
R
rackmount
E310f/s 14
E610f/s 12
RAID
block and double parity stripe
236
block and parity stripe 235
enhanced mirror 234
introduction 231
mirror 233
mirror + stripe 237
stripe 232
striping of distributed parity
238
striping of double parity 240
RAID levels
changing 252
choosing 242
logical drive 47, 124, 127, 168
RAID 0 232, 242
RAID 1 233, 242
RAID 10 237, 244
RAID 1E 234, 243
RAID 5 235, 243
RAID 50 238, 244
RAID 6 236, 243
RAID 60 240, 244
read cache
physical drive 117, 162
322
Index
reported events, cont.
logical drive 279, 280
Media Patrol 280
online capacity expansion 280,
SAS, cont.
data connection 26
data port 26, 27
data/cascade port 26, 27
expansion port 26
HBA card 27, 28, 30
initiator 85, 140, 185
management connection 26
port settings 84, 184
port statistics 85, 185
scheduling background activities
281
PDM 281
physical drive 281, 282
power supply 283
power supply fan 283
RAID level migration 283
rebuild 284
Redundancy Check 285
resource not available 285
SMART error 286
Spare Check 285
spare drive 286
stripe level migration 286
synchronization 287
system 287
transition 287
watermark 288
resource not available reported
event 285
restart the subsystem 104, 211,
69
sector size 47, 125, 128, 168, 174
defined 245
security certificate 49
serial cable connections 32
serial connection 148
setting up 35
setting lock 70, 153
settings
background activities 66, 186
buzzer 115, 212
CIM 95, 203
controller 107, 156
controller management port 77
disk array 127, 170, 171
email 90, 199
enclosure 112, 160
Fibre Channel ports 80, 181
logical drive 136, 176, 177,
215, 216, 217
restore default settings 101, 208
returning product for repair 309
revertible spare drive 132, 141,
142, 143, 190, 191, 257
RJ11-to-DB9 connector 11, 32
RJ45 connector 21, 26, 299
RMA number 310
RS232 connection 32
running background activities 67
runtime event log 63, 188, 269
S
SAN, Fibre Channel
SAS
connector 24
DAS 27
250
NetSend 96, 203
physical drive 118
physical drives 116, 162
restore default 101, 208
SLP 91, 200
SNMP 93, 201
spare drive 143, 191
subsystem management port
21
77, 179
93, 201
Telnet
323
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
settings, cont.
temperature 112, 160
user 72, 73, 197, 198
Web Server 91, 200
severity of events 73, 96, 204
SFP information 81, 182
shutdown the subsystem 103, 209
SLP
service 91, 200
settings 91, 200
SMART 107, 156
SMART error 286
SNMP
MIB files 311
service 95, 202
settings 93, 201
trap sinks 94, 202
Software Services 90
Spare Check 144, 191
reported events 285
spare drive 251, 289
create 142, 190
delete 143
locate 141
reported events 286
select physical drive 142, 190
settings 143, 191
Spare Check 144, 191
transition 132
view 141
Spare Drive Check 69
specifications 8
stale condition 119, 163
statistics
clear 102, 207
controller 107, 155
Fibre Channel 81, 182
physical drive 118, 163
SAS 85, 185
status
controller 105, 155
status, cont.
cooling unit 112, 159
Fibre Channel 79
logical drive 134, 176
physical drive 117, 163
power supply 112, 158
spare drive 141
subsystem lock 70, 153
Storage Network 60
stripe level migration reported
event 286
stripe size 47, 124, 128, 168, 174
defined 245
subsystem
alias 62, 152
cascading 28, 112, 161
configuration, save as text file
62
date and time 37, 39, 63, 154
fully booted 303
information 61
lock 70, 153
logging into 60
maintenance 213
management port settings 77,
179
Media Patrol 153
redundancy 62, 152
restart 104, 211, 215,
217
216,
shutdown 103, 209
storage network 60
subtractive-routed port 24, 28,
switch
Fibre Channel 21, 22, 24
synchronization
disk array 126, 170
logical drive 134, 135
new logical drive 128
rate 66, 187
reported events 287
324
30
Index
system reported event 287
user, cont.
database, import 99
delete 76, 198
event subscriptions 73
logout others 76
password, change 74
privileges 75, 197
settings 72, 73, 197, 198
view 72, 196
view sessions 76
username and password
CLI/CLU 35, 148
WebPAM PROe 43, 52
T
Table Rounding 108, 156, 251
table-routed port 24, 28, 30
Technical Support, contact 305
Telnet
connection 148
service 93, 201
settings 93, 201
temperature
enclosure 112, 159
terminal emulation program 35
test
buzzer 115
email 74, 90
TFTP server 213, 216
timing out, WebPAM PROe 304
topology
enclosure 111, 161
Fibre Channel 81, 182
Transition
automatic 259
defined 257
manual 259
rate 67, 187
reported events 287
spare drive 132
transport disk array 132, 171
transport ready
disk array 126, 170
logical drive 135
trap sinks 94, 202
V
view
background activities 66
controllers 105
disk arrays 121
enclosure 110
Fibre Channel logged in devices 82, 181
Fibre Channel port settings 79,
181
Fibre Channel port statistics
81, 182
list of all logical drives 145
lock status 70
LUN map 88
physical drives 116
scheduled activities 68
SFP information 81, 182
spare drives 141
users 72, 196
virtual management port 36, 77,
U
179, 301
unpacking the VTrak 11
UPS support 32
user
create 75, 196
database, export 98
voltage, enclosure
325
112, 159
VTrak E-Class Product Manual
VTrak
architectural description
beeping 262, 289
features and benefits 5
J300s 24, 26, 30
overview 2
rackmount E310f/s 14
rackmount E610f/s 12
specifications 8
unpacking 11
warranty 9
WebPAM PROe 44, 54
access over an intranet 304
access over the Internet 49
Event Frame 58
Header 56
initial setup using 42
interface 55
log in 42, 52
log out 48, 59
Management View 58
no browser connection 301
problem reporting 271, 289
times out 304
Tree View 57
username and password 43,
4
W
warranty 308
watermark
orphan 108, 155
reported events 288
Web Server
service 92, 200
settings 91, 200
52
write cache policy 48,
125, 128,
136, 168, 174
defined 247
physical drive 117, 162
write check table 139
Y
yellow !
326
262, 271, 295